]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi
Turn HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK into a target hook
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
CommitLineData
aad93da1 1@c Copyright (C) 1988-2017 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
889fd92b 2@c This is part of the GCC manual.
3@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5@node Target Macros
a767736d 6@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
889fd92b 7@cindex machine description macros
8@cindex target description macros
9@cindex macros, target description
10@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13includes a C header file conventionally given the name
a767736d 14@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
7fe22e19 20source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
a767736d 21containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
889fd92b 25
26@menu
7fe22e19 27* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
889fd92b 28* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
8ae77b3c 29* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
ab5beff9 30* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
889fd92b 31* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
c24c5fac 36* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
889fd92b 37* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
f2d0e9f1 40* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
889fd92b 41* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
42* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
747af5e7 43* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
889fd92b 44* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
c24c5fac 45* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
889fd92b 46* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
badfe841 48* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
18862b5a 49* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
e3c541f0 50* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
38475469 51* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
8d85666f 52* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
7988d6e2 53* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
c1dc02de 54* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
bd1a81f7 55* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
889fd92b 56* Misc:: Everything else.
57@end menu
58
a767736d 59@node Target Structure
7fe22e19 60@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
a767736d 61@cindex target hooks
62@cindex target functions
63
57e4bbfb 64@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
65The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
a767736d 66which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
67machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
68@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
69used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
70for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
71macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
72@smallexample
73#include "target.h"
74#include "target-def.h"
75
76/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
77
e3c541f0 78#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
79#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
a767736d 80
57e4bbfb 81struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
a767736d 82@end smallexample
83@end deftypevar
84
85Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
7fe22e19 86form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
a767736d 87``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
88from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
7fe22e19 89@code{targetm} structure.
a767736d 90
c94b1d0e 91Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
92specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
93Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
851d9296 94initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
c94b1d0e 95@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
96themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
97@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
98
3e87b980 99Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
100are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
101documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
102@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
103@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
104@file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
105@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
106@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
107default definition is used.
108
889fd92b 109@node Driver
110@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
111@cindex driver
112@cindex controlling the compilation driver
113
114@c prevent bad page break with this line
115You can control the compilation driver.
116
d37d6c0b 117@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
73023f49 118A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
119initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
120
d0faeb9d 121The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
122default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
123choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
124applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
125options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
126using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
73023f49 127
128This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
129options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
130that the other specs are easier to write.
131
132Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
d37d6c0b 133@end defmac
73023f49 134
d37d6c0b 135@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
7dd97ab6 136A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
137@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
138for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
139outermost pair of surrounding braces.
140
141The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
142the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
143to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
144@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
145everywhere it occurs.
146
147The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
148default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
149the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
150
151Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
d37d6c0b 152@end defmac
7dd97ab6 153
d37d6c0b 154@defmac CPP_SPEC
e8e57187 155A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
0858e3a2 156pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
157give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
889fd92b 158
159Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
d37d6c0b 160@end defmac
889fd92b 161
d37d6c0b 162@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
96842e40 163This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
0858e3a2 164than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
96842e40 165@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
d37d6c0b 166@end defmac
96842e40 167
d37d6c0b 168@defmac CC1_SPEC
e8e57187 169A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
f0c54b83 170pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
171front ends.
e8e57187 172It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
8ae77b3c 173for GCC to pass to front ends.
889fd92b 174
175Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
d37d6c0b 176@end defmac
889fd92b 177
d37d6c0b 178@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
e8e57187 179A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
889fd92b 180pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
e8e57187 181give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
889fd92b 182
183Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
575a7f14 184Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
185@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
0858e3a2 186CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
d37d6c0b 187@end defmac
889fd92b 188
d37d6c0b 189@defmac ASM_SPEC
e8e57187 190A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
889fd92b 191pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
e8e57187 192you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
889fd92b 193See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
194
195Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
d37d6c0b 196@end defmac
889fd92b 197
d37d6c0b 198@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
e8e57187 199A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
889fd92b 200run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
201Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
202an example of this.
203
204Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
d37d6c0b 205@end defmac
889fd92b 206
d37d6c0b 207@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
805e22b2 208Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
209an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
210read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
211output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
212@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
213
214If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
215standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
216cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
217see @file{mips.h} for instance.
d37d6c0b 218@end defmac
805e22b2 219
d37d6c0b 220@defmac LINK_SPEC
e8e57187 221A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
889fd92b 222pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
e8e57187 223give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
889fd92b 224
225Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
d37d6c0b 226@end defmac
889fd92b 227
d37d6c0b 228@defmac LIB_SPEC
889fd92b 229Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
230between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
231command given to the linker.
232
233If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
234loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
d37d6c0b 235@end defmac
889fd92b 236
d37d6c0b 237@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
e8e57187 238Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
889fd92b 239how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
240linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
241the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
242
e8e57187 243If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
8ae77b3c 244passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
d37d6c0b 245@end defmac
889fd92b 246
ecbfdc87 247@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
248By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
249@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
250instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
2c19433a 251depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
252@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
ecbfdc87 253targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
254@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
255driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
256line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
257@end defmac
258
09d17c34 259@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
260A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
261mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
8aaed91d 262generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
263shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
09d17c34 264static exception handler library, when linking without any of
265@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
266@end defmac
267
268@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
269If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
270When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
271the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
272@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
273@end defmac
274
d37d6c0b 275@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
889fd92b 276Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
277difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
278the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
279
280If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
281standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
d37d6c0b 282@end defmac
889fd92b 283
d37d6c0b 284@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
889fd92b 285Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
287the very end of the command given to the linker.
288
289Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
d37d6c0b 290@end defmac
889fd92b 291
d37d6c0b 292@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
d1cac662 293GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
294However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
295models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
296@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
297blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
298default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
299@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
d37d6c0b 300@end defmac
d1cac662 301
d37d6c0b 302@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
894b8fd9 303Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
304configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
305et al, within sysroot+suffix.
d37d6c0b 306@end defmac
4ea70922 307
d37d6c0b 308@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
894b8fd9 309Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
310GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
20820693 311updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
4ea70922 312usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
d37d6c0b 313@end defmac
4ea70922 314
d37d6c0b 315@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
889fd92b 316Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
317@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
318@code{CC1_SPEC}.
319
320The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
321containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
322string constant that provides the specification.
323
324Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
325
326@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
8ae77b3c 327related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
889fd92b 328to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
329these definitions.
330
331For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
332define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
333used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
334used.
335
336The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
337
a0ecd6b1 338@smallexample
889fd92b 339#define EXTRA_SPECS \
340 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
341
342#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
a0ecd6b1 343@end smallexample
889fd92b 344
345The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
346@smallexample
347#undef CPP_SPEC
348#define CPP_SPEC \
349"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
82aa4d68 350%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
351%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
889fd92b 352%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
353
354#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
356@end smallexample
357
358while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
359@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
360
361@smallexample
362#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
363#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
364@end smallexample
d37d6c0b 365@end defmac
889fd92b 366
d37d6c0b 367@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
889fd92b 368Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
369@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
8ae77b3c 370the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
d37d6c0b 371@end defmac
889fd92b 372
d37d6c0b 373@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
da98d114 374The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
d37d6c0b 376@end defmac
da98d114 377
0ed9e37f 378@defmac POST_LINK_SPEC
379Define this macro to add additional steps to be executed after linker.
380The default value of this macro is empty string.
381@end defmac
382
d37d6c0b 383@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
9e042f31 384A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
385linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
386change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
387define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
388line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
da98d114 389the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
390@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
d37d6c0b 391@end defmac
9e042f31 392
3e87b980 393@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
394True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
395@end deftypevr
396
d37d6c0b 397@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
889fd92b 398Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
399string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
400target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
401@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
402
403Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
404the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
405@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
406@xref{Target Fragment}.
d37d6c0b 407@end defmac
889fd92b 408
d37d6c0b 409@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
228c76d8 410Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
8ae77b3c 411a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
889fd92b 412indicates an absolute file name.
d37d6c0b 413@end defmac
889fd92b 414
d37d6c0b 415@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
889fd92b 416If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
417@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
cf93b7e8 418when the compiler is built as a cross
3fa75b2d 419compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
e757a6a8 420to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.ac}.
d37d6c0b 421@end defmac
889fd92b 422
d37d6c0b 423@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
889fd92b 424Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
1fbb4a86 425standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
889fd92b 426try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
1fbb4a86 427@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
428is built as a cross compiler.
d37d6c0b 429@end defmac
889fd92b 430
3c2ba0de 431@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
432Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
433standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
434when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
435@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
436is built as a cross compiler.
437@end defmac
438
439@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
440Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
441standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
442default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
443@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
444is built as a cross compiler.
445@end defmac
446
d37d6c0b 447@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
889fd92b 448If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
449standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
cf93b7e8 450compiler is built as a cross compiler.
d37d6c0b 451@end defmac
889fd92b 452
d37d6c0b 453@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
889fd92b 454If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
cf93b7e8 455standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
456cross compiler.
d37d6c0b 457@end defmac
889fd92b 458
d37d6c0b 459@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
0dbd1c74 460Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
889fd92b 461variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
462loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
463initialize the necessary environment variables.
d37d6c0b 464@end defmac
889fd92b 465
d37d6c0b 466@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
889fd92b 467Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
468standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
469try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
638454a1 470comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
471@file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
889fd92b 472
747af5e7 473Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
474replacement.
d37d6c0b 475@end defmac
889fd92b 476
638454a1 477@defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
478The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
0dbd1c74 479See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
480If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
d37d6c0b 481@end defmac
0dbd1c74 482
d37d6c0b 483@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
889fd92b 484Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
0dbd1c74 485for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
486usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
638454a1 487@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
488@code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
889fd92b 489and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
0858e3a2 490and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
889fd92b 491@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
492
493The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
0dbd1c74 494Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
bf9a4612 495string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
496for C++-only directories,
0dbd1c74 497and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
498wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
499the array with a null element.
500
501The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
f613a8c9 502if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
bf9a4612 503or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
0dbd1c74 504operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
505
0dbd1c74 506For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
889fd92b 507
a0ecd6b1 508@smallexample
889fd92b 509#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
510@{ \
0dbd1c74 511 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
512 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
513 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
514 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
515 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
889fd92b 516@}
a0ecd6b1 517@end smallexample
d37d6c0b 518@end defmac
889fd92b 519
520Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
521
522@enumerate
523@item
8ae77b3c 524Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
889fd92b 525
526@item
9506999b 527The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
15b474a2 528is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
9506999b 529@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
889fd92b 530
531@item
532The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
533
534@item
9506999b 535The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
15b474a2 536in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
889fd92b 537
538@item
15b474a2 539The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
889fd92b 540
541@item
15b474a2 542The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
9506999b 543
544@item
15b474a2 545The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
9506999b 546compiler.
889fd92b 547@end enumerate
548
549Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
550
551@enumerate
552@item
8ae77b3c 553Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
889fd92b 554
555@item
9506999b 556The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
557value based on the installed toolchain location.
889fd92b 558
559@item
560The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
397f1574 561(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
889fd92b 562
563@item
9506999b 564The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
15b474a2 565in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
889fd92b 566
567@item
9506999b 568The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
569
570@item
15b474a2 571The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
9506999b 572compiler.
889fd92b 573
574@item
15b474a2 575The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
9506999b 576native compiler, or we have a target system root.
889fd92b 577
578@item
15b474a2 579The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
9506999b 580native compiler, or we have a target system root.
889fd92b 581
582@item
9506999b 583The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
584If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
585the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
889fd92b 586
587@item
9506999b 588The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
589compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
889fd92b 590@file{/lib/}.
591
592@item
9506999b 593The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
594compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
889fd92b 595@file{/usr/lib/}.
596@end enumerate
597
598@node Run-time Target
599@section Run-time Target Specification
600@cindex run-time target specification
601@cindex predefined macros
602@cindex target specifications
603
604@c prevent bad page break with this line
605Here are run-time target specifications.
606
d37d6c0b 607@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
36a259fd 608This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
6daf3d3a 609built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
4fa57f2d 610the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
fd6f6435 611@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
36a259fd 612calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
613finished command line option processing your code can use those
614results freely.
1ed9d5f5 615
616@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
617command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
abdbd1cf 618the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
1ed9d5f5 619accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
620
abdbd1cf 621@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
1ed9d5f5 622object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
abdbd1cf 623@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
1ed9d5f5 624defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
625with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
626only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
627example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
628and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
629@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
630defines only @code{_ABI64}.
631
08eedad6 632You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
633@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
634or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
635assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
636macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
fa2b6990 637to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
5b6d07c4 638variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
639@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
640preprocessing.
d37d6c0b 641@end defmac
08eedad6 642
d37d6c0b 643@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
36a259fd 644Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645and is used for the target operating system instead.
d37d6c0b 646@end defmac
36a259fd 647
d37d6c0b 648@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
6abe46e3 649Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
650and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
651macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
652it yourself.
d37d6c0b 653@end defmac
6abe46e3 654
d37d6c0b 655@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
ff05e09e 656This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
657any target-specific headers.
d37d6c0b 658@end deftypevar
889fd92b 659
218e3e4e 660@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
ff05e09e 661This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
662Its default setting is 0.
48a84cee 663@end deftypevr
ff05e09e 664
6c3bc3be 665@cindex optional hardware or system features
666@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
667
218e3e4e 668@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
ff05e09e 669This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
670target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
671(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
672processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
673definition does nothing but return true.
674
fba5dd52 675@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
676@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
677storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
678option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
679via attributes).
ff05e09e 680@end deftypefn
681
c94b1d0e 682@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
b9fc964a 683This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
684target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
685definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
686option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
78d39c62 687valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
688default definition does nothing but return false.
b9fc964a 689
690In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
691options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
692only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
693should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
694@end deftypefn
695
c94b1d0e 696@deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
1f6616ee 697Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
698@end deftypefn
699
ff6624bc 700@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
701Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
702@end deftypefn
703
704@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
705Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
706@end deftypefn
707
c94b1d0e 708@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
1f6616ee 709If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
710@end deftypefn
711
c94b1d0e 712@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
1f6616ee 713If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
d4238e8b 714@end deftypefn
715
4bec06b3 716@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
cc5d3821 717This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
4bec06b3 718but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
719pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
720attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
cc5d3821 721when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
722actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
4bec06b3 723@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
724@end deftypefn
725
3bf418bd 726@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
4c834714 727This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
728but is only used in the C
3bf418bd 729language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
730used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
731frontends.
732@end defmac
733
218e3e4e 734@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
889fd92b 735Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
c17f64cc 736various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
737options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
738options are processed once
889fd92b 739just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
c17f64cc 740of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
b59688ee 741options passed explicitly.
889fd92b 742
c17f64cc 743This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
a50eecc9 744options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
745@code{optimize} attribute.
c17f64cc 746@end deftypevr
889fd92b 747
218e3e4e 748@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
cc07c468 749Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
750@end deftypefn
751
6a2fc14e 752@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
686e2769 753Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
754@end deftypefn
755
821d4118 756@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
757Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
758during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
759the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
760can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
761and @code{nomips16} attributes.
762
763Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
764registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
765operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
766in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
767significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
768for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
769switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
770
771Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
772is 0.
773@end defmac
774
4c866b9b 775@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
776Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
777@end deftypefn
778
ab5beff9 779@node Per-Function Data
780@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
781@cindex per-function data
782@cindex data structures
783
784If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
785provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
786using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
787nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
788when another one comes along.
789
790GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
791contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
792structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
793@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
794to their own specific data.
795
796If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
1f3233d1 797@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
798This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
799@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
ab5beff9 800
801One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
802RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
803RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
804function, for level 0.
805
70c2c81c 806Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
ab5beff9 807all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
808function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
809stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
810stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
3b0848a2 811@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
ab5beff9 812the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
813single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
814longer supported.
815
d37d6c0b 816@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
18566b13 817Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
ab5beff9 818is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
18566b13 819The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
d37d6c0b 820function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
821@end defmac
ab5beff9 822
d37d6c0b 823@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
824If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
825function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
826target to perform any target specific initialization of the
827@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
828used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
ab5beff9 829
b3d47662 830@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
1f3233d1 831Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
ba72912a 832GC allocation, including the structure itself.
d37d6c0b 833@end deftypevar
ab5beff9 834
889fd92b 835@node Storage Layout
836@section Storage Layout
837@cindex storage layout
838
839Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
840alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
841expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
842@xref{Run-time Target}.
843
d37d6c0b 844@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
889fd92b 845Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
846byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
847This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
848bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
849be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
850macro need not be a constant.
851
852This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
853bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
d37d6c0b 854@end defmac
889fd92b 855
d37d6c0b 856@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
889fd92b 857Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
858word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
d37d6c0b 859@end defmac
889fd92b 860
d37d6c0b 861@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
889fd92b 862Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
863most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
76c64076 864memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
865order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
889fd92b 866macro need not be a constant.
d37d6c0b 867@end defmac
889fd92b 868
76c64076 869@defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
870On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
871registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
872the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
873the order of words in memory.
874@end defmac
875
d37d6c0b 876@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
889fd92b 877Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
878@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
879containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
880have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
881
882You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
883multi-word integers.
d37d6c0b 884@end defmac
889fd92b 885
d37d6c0b 886@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
6852ad78 887Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
888is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
d37d6c0b 889@end defmac
889fd92b 890
d37d6c0b 891@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
889fd92b 892Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
893@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
894largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
d37d6c0b 895@end defmac
889fd92b 896
d37d6c0b 897@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
a0d5cf71 898Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
899register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
d37d6c0b 900@end defmac
889fd92b 901
d37d6c0b 902@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
889fd92b 903Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
904@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
905smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
d37d6c0b 906@end defmac
889fd92b 907
d37d6c0b 908@defmac POINTER_SIZE
889fd92b 909Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
910width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
3cf24182 911you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
912a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
d37d6c0b 913@end defmac
889fd92b 914
d37d6c0b 915@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
eade63c3 916A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
917@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
918greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
919should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
920is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
921@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
922
923You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
924and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
d37d6c0b 925@end defmac
889fd92b 926
d37d6c0b 927@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
889fd92b 928A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
929is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
930stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
931scalar type.
932
933On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
934register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
935@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
936cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
937floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
938counterparts.
939
940For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
941However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
942either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
943the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
944sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
945@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
946
947Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
d37d6c0b 948@end defmac
889fd92b 949
069d39e6 950@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum flt_eval_method} TARGET_C_EXCESS_PRECISION (enum excess_precision_type @var{type})
db02e0ad 951Return a value, with the same meaning as the C99 macro @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} that describes which excess precision should be applied. @var{type} is either @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD}. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, the target should return which precision and range operations will be implictly evaluated in regardless of the excess precision explicitly added. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} and @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, the target should return the explicit excess precision that should be added depending on the value set for @option{-fexcess-precision=@r{[}standard@r{|}fast@r{]}}. Note that unpredictable explicit excess precision does not make sense, so a target should never return @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD_UNPREDICTABLE} when @var{type} is @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}.
069d39e6 952@end deftypefn
953
3754d046 954@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
3b2411a8 955Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
956function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
957and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
958change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
959pointer} types.
960
c879dbcf 961@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
962return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
963@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
964If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
965which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
966then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
967the signedness may be different.
968
adaf4ef0 969@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
970
3b2411a8 971The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
972also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
973if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
45550790 974@end deftypefn
889fd92b 975
d37d6c0b 976@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
889fd92b 977Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
978bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
979regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
980size of an integer.
d37d6c0b 981@end defmac
889fd92b 982
d37d6c0b 983@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
9dc9d0d3 984Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
985stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
986desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
987if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
988this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
d37d6c0b 989@end defmac
dfb1ee39 990
d37d6c0b 991@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
9dc9d0d3 992Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
993stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
994is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
995macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
996@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
d37d6c0b 997@end defmac
889fd92b 998
27a7a23a 999@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1000Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1001from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
1002to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1003@end defmac
1004
d37d6c0b 1005@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
889fd92b 1006Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
d37d6c0b 1007@end defmac
889fd92b 1008
d37d6c0b 1009@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
b9bbc279 1010Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1011bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1012just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
d37d6c0b 1013@end defmac
889fd92b 1014
41971a20 1015@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1016If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment
1017that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,
1018@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.
1019@end deftypevr
1020
65c05dfd 1021@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1022Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1023provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1024@end defmac
1025
02421213 1026@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1027Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1028not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1029@end defmac
1030
d37d6c0b 1031@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
071cd279 1032If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1033object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1034nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1035on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
d37d6c0b 1036@end defmac
071cd279 1037
d37d6c0b 1038@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
aca14577 1039Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1040machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1041structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1042by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
d37d6c0b 1043@end defmac
889fd92b 1044
700a9760 1045@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{type}, @var{computed})
1046An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} of
1047type @var{type} if the alignment computed in the usual way (including
1048applying of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
77d0f168 1049alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1050field alignment has not been set by the
700a9760 1051@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. Note that @var{field}
1052may be @code{NULL_TREE} in case we just query for the minimum alignment
1053of a field of type @var{type} in structure context.
d37d6c0b 1054@end defmac
889fd92b 1055
27a7a23a 1056@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1057Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1058to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1059
1060If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1061
1062@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1063@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1064@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1065@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1066@end defmac
1067
d37d6c0b 1068@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
889fd92b 1069Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1070Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1071@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1072the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
6d557294 1073
1074On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1075the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
3a4303e7 1076a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
6d557294 1077On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1078@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
d37d6c0b 1079@end defmac
889fd92b 1080
d37d6c0b 1081@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
bac628bc 1082If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
e13a110e 1083the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1084the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
889fd92b 1085macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1086
1087If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1088
1089@findex strcpy
1090One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1091make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1092arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1093constants to character arrays can be done inline.
d37d6c0b 1094@end defmac
889fd92b 1095
a16734cd 1096@defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1097Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1098some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1099AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1100must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1101
1102If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1103@end defmac
1104
d37d6c0b 1105@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
889fd92b 1106If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1107that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1108@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1109have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1110align the object.
1111
e532afed 1112The default definition just returns @var{basic-align}.
889fd92b 1113
1114The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1115constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1116constants can be done inline.
d37d6c0b 1117@end defmac
889fd92b 1118
d37d6c0b 1119@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
bac628bc 1120If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
9bd87fd2 1121the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1122the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1123macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1124
1125If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1126
1127One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1128make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
c6e790c5 1129
2f05705b 1130If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
d37d6c0b 1131@end defmac
9bd87fd2 1132
482a44fa 1133@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1134This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1135@var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1136require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1137this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1138the vector element type.
1139@end deftypefn
1140
ad33891d 1141@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1142If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1143@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1144and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1145have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1146align the slot.
1147
1148If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1149@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1150be used.
1151
1152This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1153of all possible modes which the slot may have.
c6e790c5 1154
2f05705b 1155If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
ad33891d 1156@end defmac
1157
76cbc2a0 1158@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1159If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1160variable @var{decl}.
1161
1162If this macro is not defined, then
1163@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1164is used.
1165
1166One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1167make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
c6e790c5 1168
2f05705b 1169If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
76cbc2a0 1170@end defmac
1171
8645d3e7 1172@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1173If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1174for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1175@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1176
1177If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1178@end defmac
1179
d37d6c0b 1180@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
8e5fcce7 1181Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
889fd92b 1182empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1183
f5712181 1184If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
d37d6c0b 1185@end defmac
889fd92b 1186
d37d6c0b 1187@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
889fd92b 1188Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1189Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1190
1191If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1192@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
d37d6c0b 1193@end defmac
889fd92b 1194
d37d6c0b 1195@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
889fd92b 1196Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1197if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1198go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
d37d6c0b 1199@end defmac
889fd92b 1200
d37d6c0b 1201@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
889fd92b 1202Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
8e5fcce7 1203alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
889fd92b 1204
4975da72 1205The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1206@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1207structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1208that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1209that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1210
1211Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1212@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1213four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1214not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1215
1216An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1217structure.
889fd92b 1218
1219If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1220a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1221
1222Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
8e5fcce7 1223bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
889fd92b 1224support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1225@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1226
8e5fcce7 1227The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
889fd92b 1228@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1229Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1230
8e5fcce7 1231Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
889fd92b 1232@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1233@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1234
e8e57187 1235If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
8e5fcce7 1236bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
889fd92b 1237what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1238
a0ecd6b1 1239@smallexample
889fd92b 1240struct foo1
1241@{
1242 char x;
1243 char :0;
1244 char y;
1245@};
1246
1247struct foo2
1248@{
1249 char x;
1250 int :0;
1251 char y;
1252@};
1253
1254main ()
1255@{
1256 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1257 sizeof (struct foo1));
1258 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1259 sizeof (struct foo2));
1260 exit (0);
1261@}
a0ecd6b1 1262@end smallexample
889fd92b 1263
1264If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1265get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
d37d6c0b 1266@end defmac
889fd92b 1267
d37d6c0b 1268@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
f04f096b 1269Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1270to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
d37d6c0b 1271@end defmac
889fd92b 1272
e366f125 1273@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
25ba5be6 1274When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1275whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1276structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1277the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1278@end deftypefn
1279
e366f125 1280@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
5f458503 1281This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1282should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1283these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1284
866cf42b 1285The default is @code{false}.
5f458503 1286@end deftypefn
1287
3754d046 1288@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode})
f91ed644 1289Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1290be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
bf9a4612 1291
24a94ef6 1292If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1293mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1294case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1295retain the field's mode.
1296
99c77e32 1297Normally, this is not needed.
f91ed644 1298@end deftypefn
bf9a4612 1299
d37d6c0b 1300@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
10c64b6a 1301Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1302by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1303way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
889fd92b 1304@var{specified}.
1305
1306The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1307the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
d37d6c0b 1308@end defmac
889fd92b 1309
d37d6c0b 1310@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
889fd92b 1311An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1312machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1313this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1314appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1315(DImode)} is assumed.
d37d6c0b 1316@end defmac
889fd92b 1317
d37d6c0b 1318@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
3754d046 1319If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
3469a3e2 1320specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1321@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1322@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1323@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1324having its mode specified.
be334077 1325
1326You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1327would most commonly define this macro if the
1328@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
132964-bit mode.
d37d6c0b 1330@end defmac
be334077 1331
d37d6c0b 1332@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
3754d046 1333If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
3469a3e2 1334specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1335@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1336
1337You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1338You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1339pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
d37d6c0b 1340@end defmac
3469a3e2 1341
f77c4496 1342@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
0ef89dfd 1343This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1344of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1345@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1346targets.
1347@end deftypefn
1348
f77c4496 1349@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
0ef89dfd 1350This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1351of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1352@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1353targets.
1354@end deftypefn
1355
f77c4496 1356@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
141a2500 1357Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1358The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1359@end deftypefn
1360
53edaaf2 1361@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
f04f096b 1362This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1363@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1364Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1365unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1366different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1367alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1368bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1369the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1370(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
8af8271b 1371another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
f04f096b 1372other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
8642f3d3 1373
1374When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1375of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1376bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1377and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
b3d47662 1378chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1379size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
8642f3d3 1380alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1381
1382If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
b3d47662 1383the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
8642f3d3 1384used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1385precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1386may affect its placement.
f04f096b 1387@end deftypefn
1388
53edaaf2 1389@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
c4503c0a 1390Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
c4503c0a 1391@end deftypefn
1392
53edaaf2 1393@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
9421ebb9 1394Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1395@end deftypefn
1396
bc5e6ea1 1397@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1398This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1399to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1400For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1401for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1402registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1403usage.
1404@end deftypefn
1405
1406@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1407This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1408that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1409@end deftypefn
1410
53edaaf2 1411@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
eddcdde1 1412If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1413uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1414to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1415mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1416the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1417not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1418for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1419return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1420string constant.
333715c2 1421
1422Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1423qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1424fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1425is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1426length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1427ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1428@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1429@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1430code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1431@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1432codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1433spaces in your string.
1434
eddcdde1 1435This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1436name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1437can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1438before mangling.
1439
333715c2 1440The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1441appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1442types.
1443@end deftypefn
1444
889fd92b 1445@node Type Layout
1446@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1447
1448These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1449basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1450the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1451languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1452
d37d6c0b 1453@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
889fd92b 1454A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1455target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
d37d6c0b 1456@end defmac
889fd92b 1457
d37d6c0b 1458@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
889fd92b 1459A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1460target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1461(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1462unit.)
d37d6c0b 1463@end defmac
889fd92b 1464
d37d6c0b 1465@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
889fd92b 1466A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1467target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
d37d6c0b 1468@end defmac
889fd92b 1469
d37d6c0b 1470@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
cf2d31ab 1471On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
b3d47662 1472@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
cf2d31ab 1473that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1474the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1475value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
d37d6c0b 1476@end defmac
cf2d31ab 1477
d37d6c0b 1478@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
889fd92b 1479A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1480target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
b01e21ca 1481words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
889fd92b 1482macro must be at least 64.
d37d6c0b 1483@end defmac
889fd92b 1484
d37d6c0b 1485@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
889fd92b 1486A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
79fa2a87 1487target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1488@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
d37d6c0b 1489@end defmac
889fd92b 1490
d37d6c0b 1491@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
2a9f48dd 1492A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1493C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1494this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
d37d6c0b 1495@end defmac
46150a74 1496
d37d6c0b 1497@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
889fd92b 1498A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1499target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
d37d6c0b 1500@end defmac
889fd92b 1501
d37d6c0b 1502@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
889fd92b 1503A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1504target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1505words.
d37d6c0b 1506@end defmac
889fd92b 1507
d37d6c0b 1508@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
889fd92b 1509A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1510the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1511words.
d37d6c0b 1512@end defmac
889fd92b 1513
06f0b99c 1514@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1515A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1516the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1517@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1518@end defmac
1519
1520@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1521A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1522the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1523@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1524@end defmac
1525
1526@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1527A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1528the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1529@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1530@end defmac
1531
1532@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1533A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1534the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1535@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1536@end defmac
1537
1538@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1539A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1540the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1541@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1542@end defmac
1543
1544@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1545A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1546the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1547@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1548@end defmac
1549
1550@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1551A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1552the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1553@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1554@end defmac
1555
1556@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1557A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1558the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1559@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1560@end defmac
1561
f308a9b2 1562@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1563This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1564hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1565causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1566prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1567uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1568the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1569@end defmac
1570
d37d6c0b 1571@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
0dbd1c74 1572A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1573supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1574value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1575If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1576is the default.
d37d6c0b 1577@end defmac
0dbd1c74 1578
d37d6c0b 1579@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
889fd92b 1580An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1581@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
8ae77b3c 1582always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1583and @option{-funsigned-char}.
d37d6c0b 1584@end defmac
889fd92b 1585
bfb835d3 1586@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1587This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1588@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1589of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
d5871f40 1590@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1591
bfb835d3 1592The default is to return false.
1593@end deftypefn
d5871f40 1594
d37d6c0b 1595@defmac SIZE_TYPE
889fd92b 1596A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1597for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1598contents of the string.
1599
1600The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1601spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1602appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1603of the data type names defined in the function
816c3ff2 1604@code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1605You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1606compiler to crash on startup.
889fd92b 1607
1608If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1609int"}.
d37d6c0b 1610@end defmac
889fd92b 1611
748e5d45 1612@defmac SIZETYPE
1613GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1614@code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1615dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1616the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1617is extracted.
1618
1619The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1620
1621If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1622@end defmac
1623
d37d6c0b 1624@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
889fd92b 1625A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1626for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1627@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1628@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1629
1630If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
d37d6c0b 1631@end defmac
889fd92b 1632
d37d6c0b 1633@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
889fd92b 1634A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1635for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1636the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1637information.
1638
1639If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
d37d6c0b 1640@end defmac
889fd92b 1641
d37d6c0b 1642@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
889fd92b 1643A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1644characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1645@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
d37d6c0b 1646@end defmac
889fd92b 1647
d37d6c0b 1648@defmac WINT_TYPE
c239e8c5 1649A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1650use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1651@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1652contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1653information.
1654
1655If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
d37d6c0b 1656@end defmac
c239e8c5 1657
d37d6c0b 1658@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
e3fff6f2 1659A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1660can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1661The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1662string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1663
1664If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1665@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1666much precision as @code{long long int}.
d37d6c0b 1667@end defmac
e3fff6f2 1668
d37d6c0b 1669@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
e3fff6f2 1670A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1671can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1672type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1673of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1674
1675If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1676@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1677unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1678int}.
d37d6c0b 1679@end defmac
e3fff6f2 1680
f3449a3c 1681@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1682@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1683@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1684@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1685@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1686@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1687@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1688@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1689@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1690@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1691@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1692@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1693@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1694@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1695@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1696@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1697@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1698@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1699@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1700@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1701@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1702@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1703@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1704@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1705@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1706@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1707@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1708C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1709@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1710@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1711@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1712@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1713@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1714@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1715@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1716@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1717@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1718
1719If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1720type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1721@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1722to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1723these macros are null pointers.
1724@end defmac
1725
d37d6c0b 1726@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
3aba38cc 1727The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1728that looks like:
1729
a0ecd6b1 1730@smallexample
3aba38cc 1731 struct @{
1732 union @{
1733 void (*fn)();
1734 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1735 @};
1736 ptrdiff_t delta;
1737 @};
a0ecd6b1 1738@end smallexample
3aba38cc 1739
1740@noindent
1741The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1742will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1743Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1744always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1745distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1746platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1747that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1748the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1749
1750GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1751this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1752However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1753set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1754bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1755address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1756architecture, you should define this macro to
1757@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1758
1759In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1760in which function addresses are always even, according to
1761@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1762@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
d37d6c0b 1763@end defmac
6bfa2cc1 1764
d37d6c0b 1765@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
6bfa2cc1 1766Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
228c5b30 1767macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
6bfa2cc1 1768instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1769function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
228c5b30 1770data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
6bfa2cc1 1771pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1772
1773If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1774of words that the function descriptor occupies.
d37d6c0b 1775@end defmac
5c43f650 1776
d37d6c0b 1777@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
5c43f650 1778By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1779is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1780the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1781when special alignment is necessary. */
d37d6c0b 1782@end defmac
5c43f650 1783
d37d6c0b 1784@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
5c43f650 1785There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1786zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1787specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1788of words in each data entry.
d37d6c0b 1789@end defmac
e1768e2f 1790
889fd92b 1791@node Registers
1792@section Register Usage
1793@cindex register usage
1794
1795This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1796has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1797
1798The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1799done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1800on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1801For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1802For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1803
1804@menu
c24c5fac 1805* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1806* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1807* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1808* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1809* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
889fd92b 1810@end menu
1811
1812@node Register Basics
1813@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1814
1815@c prevent bad page break with this line
1816Registers have various characteristics.
1817
d37d6c0b 1818@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
889fd92b 1819Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1820numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1821pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1822@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
d37d6c0b 1823@end defmac
889fd92b 1824
d37d6c0b 1825@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
889fd92b 1826@cindex fixed register
1827An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1828all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1829general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1830pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1831register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1832machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1833and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1834
1835This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1836commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1837register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1838
1839The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1840the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1841by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
8ae77b3c 1842the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1843@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
d37d6c0b 1844@end defmac
889fd92b 1845
d37d6c0b 1846@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
889fd92b 1847@cindex call-used register
1848@cindex call-clobbered register
1849@cindex call-saved register
1850Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1851clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1852registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1853available for general allocation of values that must live across
1854function calls.
1855
1856If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1857automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1858exit, if the register is used within the function.
d37d6c0b 1859@end defmac
889fd92b 1860
d37d6c0b 1861@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
d2d242b4 1862@cindex call-used register
1863@cindex call-clobbered register
1864@cindex call-saved register
228c5b30 1865Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1866that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
d2d242b4 1867(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
228c5b30 1868This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
d2d242b4 1869of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
d37d6c0b 1870@end defmac
d2d242b4 1871
fc51ca3b 1872@cindex call-used register
1873@cindex call-clobbered register
1874@cindex call-saved register
5da94e60 1875@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1876This hook should return true if @var{regno} is partly call-saved and
1877partly call-clobbered, and if a value of mode @var{mode} would be partly
1878clobbered by a call. For example, if the low 32 bits of @var{regno} are
1879preserved across a call but higher bits are clobbered, this hook should
1880return true for a 64-bit mode but false for a 32-bit mode.
1881
1882The default implementation returns false, which is correct
1883for targets that don't have partly call-clobbered registers.
1884@end deftypefn
fc51ca3b 1885
889fd92b 1886@findex fixed_regs
1887@findex call_used_regs
d37d6c0b 1888@findex global_regs
1889@findex reg_names
1890@findex reg_class_contents
b2d7ede1 1891@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1892This hook may conditionally modify five variables
de151bb1 1893@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
747af5e7 1894@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1895any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
aaf86e2f 1896of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as boolean vectors).
747af5e7 1897@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1898@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1899called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1900@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
de151bb1 1901from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
747af5e7 1902@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
8ae77b3c 1903@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
747af5e7 1904@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1905command options have been applied.
889fd92b 1906
889fd92b 1907@cindex disabling certain registers
1908@cindex controlling register usage
1909If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1910flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1911@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
dd41ed59 1912registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make
1913@code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1914that shouldn't be used.
889fd92b 1915
1916(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1917of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1918controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1919these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
b2d7ede1 1920@end deftypefn
889fd92b 1921
d37d6c0b 1922@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
889fd92b 1923Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1924expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1925corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1926function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1927outbound register.
d37d6c0b 1928@end defmac
889fd92b 1929
d37d6c0b 1930@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
889fd92b 1931Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1932expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1933corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1934function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1935register.
d37d6c0b 1936@end defmac
889fd92b 1937
d37d6c0b 1938@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
5a37b6e0 1939Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1940expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1941register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1942need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1943gotos.
d37d6c0b 1944@end defmac
5a37b6e0 1945
d37d6c0b 1946@defmac PC_REGNUM
889fd92b 1947If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1948register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
d37d6c0b 1949@end defmac
889fd92b 1950
1951@node Allocation Order
1952@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1953@cindex order of register allocation
1954@cindex register allocation order
1955
1956@c prevent bad page break with this line
1957Registers are allocated in order.
1958
d37d6c0b 1959@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
889fd92b 1960If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
e8e57187 1961numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
889fd92b 1962to use them (from most preferred to least).
1963
1964If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1965(all else being equal).
1966
1967One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1968registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1969instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1970machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
ad87de1e 1971the highest numbered allocable register first.
d37d6c0b 1972@end defmac
889fd92b 1973
dedfd669 1974@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
889fd92b 1975A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1976hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1977
1978Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1979Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1980register; and so on.
1981
1982The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1983@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1984
1985On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
d37d6c0b 1986@end defmac
889fd92b 1987
dedfd669 1988@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1989Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
1990prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
1991using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
1992allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
d44f2f7c 1993call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
1994macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
dedfd669 1995@end defmac
1996
47dd2e78 1997@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
1998In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
1999Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2000If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2001based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2002be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2003value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2004to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2005
2006On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2007@end defmac
2008
889fd92b 2009@node Values in Registers
2010@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2011
2012This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2013(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2014consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2015
d37d6c0b 2016@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
889fd92b 2017A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2018at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
1c64e82e 2019@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
b395382f 2020cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with
2021@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} and/or @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2022instead.
889fd92b 2023
2024On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2025definition of this macro is
2026
2027@smallexample
2028#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2029 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
84bf2056 2030 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
889fd92b 2031@end smallexample
d37d6c0b 2032@end defmac
889fd92b 2033
695595bc 2034@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2035A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2036in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2037in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2038multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2039this mode by the number of registers returned by
2040@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2041
2042For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2043registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2044nonzero.
2045
2046This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
fe2ebfc8 2047@code{subreg_get_info}
695595bc 2048would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2049represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2050@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2051registers and so not be representable.
2052@end defmac
2053
2054@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2055For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2056@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2057returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2058including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2059@end defmac
2060
556e5619 2061@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2062Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2063of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2064should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2065used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2066happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2067floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2068@end defmac
2069
b395382f 2070@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2071This hook returns true if it is permissible to store a value
889fd92b 2072of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
b395382f 2073registers starting with that one). The default definition returns true
2074unconditionally.
889fd92b 2075
0dbd1c74 2076You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2077because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
889fd92b 2078
2079@cindex register pairs
2080On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
b395382f 2081register pairs. You can implement that by defining this hook to reject
0dbd1c74 2082odd register numbers for such modes.
889fd92b 2083
2084The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2085@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
0dbd1c74 2086register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2087value into the register and back out not alter it.
889fd92b 2088
0dbd1c74 2089Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2090all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
b395382f 2091this hook to distinguish between these modes, provided you define
2092patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This is
2093useful because of the interaction between @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
889fd92b 2094and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2095to be tieable.
2096
2097Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2098Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2099in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2100can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2101mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2102registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2103
2104On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2105modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2106registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2107non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
b395382f 2108@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
889fd92b 2109floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2110normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2111unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
b395382f 2112register, so you can define this hook to say so.
889fd92b 2113
2114The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2115they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2116instructions. However, this is of no concern to
b395382f 2117@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
889fd92b 2118constraints for those instructions.
2119
2120On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2121so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2122register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2123floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2124be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
b395382f 2125@end deftypefn
889fd92b 2126
a2b660e7 2127@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2128A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2129@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2130
2131One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2132another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2133handler.
2134
2135The default is always nonzero.
2136@end defmac
2137
d37d6c0b 2138@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
0dbd1c74 2139A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
ad87de1e 2140@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
889fd92b 2141
b395382f 2142If @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2143@code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same
2144for any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
0dbd1c74 2145should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2146this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
ad87de1e 2147accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
0dbd1c74 2148
2149You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
e8e57187 2150possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
0dbd1c74 2151allocation.
d37d6c0b 2152@end defmac
18aa2adf 2153
747bf50d 2154@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2155This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2156@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2157
2158One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2159is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2160
2161The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2162@end deftypefn
2163
d37d6c0b 2164@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
18aa2adf 2165Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
a61eb77e 2166registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
18aa2adf 2167@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
d37d6c0b 2168@end defmac
889fd92b 2169
2170@node Leaf Functions
2171@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2172
2173@cindex leaf functions
2174@cindex functions, leaf
2175On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2176more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2177means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2178are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2179normally arrive.
2180
2181The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2182other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2183registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2184function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2185handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2186functions''.
2187
e8e57187 2188GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
889fd92b 2189suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2190registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2191accomplish this.
2192
d37d6c0b 2193@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
7a8d641b 2194Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
889fd92b 2195contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2196function treatment.
2197
2198If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2199registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
e8e57187 2200GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
889fd92b 2201used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2202in this vector.
2203
2204Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2205the treatment of leaf functions.
d37d6c0b 2206@end defmac
889fd92b 2207
d37d6c0b 2208@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
889fd92b 2209A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2210should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2211
2212If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
8ae77b3c 2213function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
889fd92b 2214will cause the compiler to abort.
2215
2216Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2217treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2218this.
d37d6c0b 2219@end defmac
889fd92b 2220
b3b67b7c 2221@findex current_function_is_leaf
2222@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
747af5e7 2223@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2224@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2225specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2226which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2227set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
17d9b0c3 2228compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2229@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2230functions which only use leaf registers.
f317b732 2231@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2232that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2233@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
889fd92b 2234@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2235@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2236
2237@node Stack Registers
2238@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2239
2240There are special features to handle computers where some of the
d37d6c0b 2241``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2242pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2243stack.
889fd92b 2244
e8e57187 2245Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
d37d6c0b 2246they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2247support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2248point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2249stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2250@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2251with it, as well as defining these macros.
2252
2253@defmac STACK_REGS
889fd92b 2254Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
d37d6c0b 2255@end defmac
889fd92b 2256
e8eed2f8 2257@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2258This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2259the machine has any stack-like registers.
2260@end defmac
2261
d37d6c0b 2262@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
889fd92b 2263The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2264of the stack.
d37d6c0b 2265@end defmac
889fd92b 2266
d37d6c0b 2267@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
889fd92b 2268The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2269the stack.
d37d6c0b 2270@end defmac
889fd92b 2271
889fd92b 2272@node Register Classes
2273@section Register Classes
2274@cindex register class definitions
2275@cindex class definitions, register
2276
2277On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2278For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2279certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2280restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2281
2282You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2283which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2284that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2285
2286@findex ALL_REGS
2287@findex NO_REGS
2288In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2289class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2290class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2291union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2292
2293@findex GENERAL_REGS
2294One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2295terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2296@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2297the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2298to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2299
2300Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2301then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2302
2303The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2304constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2305You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2306them in operand constraints.
2307
a4621139 2308You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2309registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2310some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2311cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2312(@pxref{Costs}).
2313
889fd92b 2314You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2315instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2316either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2317certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
15edf55e 2318which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2319or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
851d9296 2320class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
889fd92b 2321
2322You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2323classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2324contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2325in their union.
2326
2327When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2328certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2329Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2330a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
b395382f 2331specify this requirement is with @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
889fd92b 2332
2333Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2334instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2335each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2336mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2337single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2338this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2339instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2340single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2341@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2342
d37d6c0b 2343@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2cf3c756 2344An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2345as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2346must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
889fd92b 2347@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2348tells how many classes there are.
2349
2350Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2351the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2352in many of the tables described below.
d37d6c0b 2353@end deftp
889fd92b 2354
d37d6c0b 2355@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
889fd92b 2356The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2357
a0ecd6b1 2358@smallexample
889fd92b 2359#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
a0ecd6b1 2360@end smallexample
d37d6c0b 2361@end defmac
889fd92b 2362
d37d6c0b 2363@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
889fd92b 2364An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2365constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
d37d6c0b 2366@end defmac
889fd92b 2367
d37d6c0b 2368@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
889fd92b 2369An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2370which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2371@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2372register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2373
2374When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2375Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2376several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2377for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
3f5e3c27 2378In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2379registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2380so on.
d37d6c0b 2381@end defmac
889fd92b 2382
d37d6c0b 2383@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
889fd92b 2384A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2385@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2386which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2387register.
d37d6c0b 2388@end defmac
889fd92b 2389
d37d6c0b 2390@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
889fd92b 2391A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2392base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2393which is the register value plus a displacement.
d37d6c0b 2394@end defmac
889fd92b 2395
d37d6c0b 2396@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2e6d14e8 2397This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
a99e98db 2398the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2e6d14e8 2399@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2400@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
d37d6c0b 2401@end defmac
2e6d14e8 2402
6006f9fd 2403@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2404A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2405base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2406register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2407addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2408@end defmac
2409
f8a8fc7b 2410@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
00cb30dc 2411A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
f8a8fc7b 2412base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2413space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2414define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2415the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2416of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
00cb30dc 2417@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2418index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2419@end defmac
2420
d37d6c0b 2421@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
889fd92b 2422A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2423index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2424address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2425added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
d37d6c0b 2426@end defmac
889fd92b 2427
d37d6c0b 2428@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
889fd92b 2429A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
d5bfc154 2430suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
d37d6c0b 2431@end defmac
889fd92b 2432
d37d6c0b 2433@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
071cd279 2434A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2435that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2436@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2437reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2438you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
284bef0e 2439@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2440addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2441@code{address_operand}.
d37d6c0b 2442@end defmac
071cd279 2443
6006f9fd 2444@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2445A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2446use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2447memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2448pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2449define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2450than other base register uses.
00cb30dc 2451
2452Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2453@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2454@end defmac
2455
f8a8fc7b 2456@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2457A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2458suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2459memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2460This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
284bef0e 2461that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2462appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2463immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2464address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2465@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2466corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
00cb30dc 2467@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
284bef0e 2468that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
6006f9fd 2469@end defmac
2470
d37d6c0b 2471@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
889fd92b 2472A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2473suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2474either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2475allocated such a hard register.
2476
2477The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2478the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2479two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2480labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2481labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2482may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2483looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2484only if neither labeling works.
d37d6c0b 2485@end defmac
889fd92b 2486
d78118a3 2487@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
00036f1c 2488A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
d78118a3 2489@end deftypefn
2490
09a17585 2491@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2492A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2493to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2494@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2495another, smaller class.
2496
2497The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2498
2499Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2500example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2501for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2502@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2503Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2504
2505One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2506@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2507loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2508force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2509immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2510instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2511register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2512@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2513into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
ca316360 2514@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
09a17585 2515of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2516
2517If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2518through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2519to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2520reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2521this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2522the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2523@end deftypefn
2524
d37d6c0b 2525@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
889fd92b 2526A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2527to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2528@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2529another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2530safe:
2531
a0ecd6b1 2532@smallexample
889fd92b 2533#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
a0ecd6b1 2534@end smallexample
889fd92b 2535
2536Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2537example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2538for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2539@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2540Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2541
9fe4f442 2542One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2543@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2544loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2545force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2546immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2547instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2548register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
fcd8b5ad 2549@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant cannot be loaded
9fe4f442 2550into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
ca316360 2551@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2552of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
897f76b2 2553
2554If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2555through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2556to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2557reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2558this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2559the SSE registers (and vice versa).
d37d6c0b 2560@end defmac
889fd92b 2561
71db0d8b 2562@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2563Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2564input reloads.
2565
2566The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2567argument.
2568
2569You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2570reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2571@end deftypefn
2572
d37d6c0b 2573@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
889fd92b 2574A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2575to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2576@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2577ordinarily be used.
2578
2579Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
fcd8b5ad 2580there are certain modes that simply cannot go in certain reload classes.
889fd92b 2581
2582The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2583smaller class.
2584
2585Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2586require the macro to do something nontrivial.
d37d6c0b 2587@end defmac
889fd92b 2588
3754d046 2589@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
889fd92b 2590Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2591from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2592@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
4d58fa46 2593from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2594term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2595directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2596register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2597destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2598source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2599reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2600and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2601intermediate register still holds the required value.
2602
2603Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2604allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2605register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2606address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2607when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
68576faf 2608as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
4d58fa46 2609that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2610describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2611these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2612of the scratch register(s).
2613
2614In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2615
2616For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
427c723a 2617and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
4d58fa46 2618@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
427c723a 2619hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
4d58fa46 2620needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2621
2622If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2623an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2624return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2625If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2626If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2627that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2628
2629If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2630perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2631closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2632required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2633copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2634
2635You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2636in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2637and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2638for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2639single-register-class
2640@c [later: or memory]
2641output constraint.
2642
2643When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2644hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2645register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2646have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2647
2648@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2649@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2650@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2651@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2652@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2653@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2654@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2655@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2656
2657
2658@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2659pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2660Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2661in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2662
2663Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2664currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2665to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2666
2667@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2668copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2669(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2670Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2671of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2672forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2673@end deftypefn
2674
2675@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2676@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2677@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
b215c058 2678These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
4d58fa46 2679@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2680
2681These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2682target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2683reload phase that it may
889fd92b 2684need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2685register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2686register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
4d58fa46 2687you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
889fd92b 2688largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2689intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2690
2691If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2692intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
4d58fa46 2693was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2694class required. If the
2695requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2696@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
889fd92b 2697macros identically.
2698
2699The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2700Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2701can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2702@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2703macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2704
2705If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
4d58fa46 2706intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
889fd92b 2707@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
4d58fa46 2708(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
889fd92b 2709implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2710@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2711register.
2712
4d58fa46 2713These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2714register that
889fd92b 2715contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2716class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2717value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2718register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2719Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2720
2721@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2722pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
8ae77b3c 2723Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
889fd92b 2724in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2725
2726These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2727registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2728registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2729would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
5d4f270c 2730the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
889fd92b 2731intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2732general registers.
d37d6c0b 2733@end defmac
889fd92b 2734
d37d6c0b 2735@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
889fd92b 2736Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2737to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
f45856ef 2738those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
889fd92b 2739@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2740class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2741and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2742
2743Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
d37d6c0b 2744@end defmac
889fd92b 2745
d37d6c0b 2746@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
889fd92b 2747Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2748allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2749If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2750defined by this macro.
2751
2752Do not define this macro if you do not define
2753@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
d37d6c0b 2754@end defmac
889fd92b 2755
d37d6c0b 2756@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
889fd92b 2757When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2758registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2759hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2760load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2761same as that of @var{mode}.
2762
2763This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2764bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2765in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2766registers.
2767
2768However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2769the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2770differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2771widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2772suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2773details.
2774
2775Do not define this macro if you do not define
2776@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2777is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
d37d6c0b 2778@end defmac
889fd92b 2779
24dd0668 2780@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2781A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2782to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2783registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2784
2785The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2786has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
957b2bdc 2787default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2788i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2789can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2790
2791This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2792transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2793pressure.
24dd0668 2794@end deftypefn
2795
3754d046 2796@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode})
d3ba22dc 2797A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2798of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2799
2800This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
4c4bf817 2801the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
d3ba22dc 2802@var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2803@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2804values in the class @var{rclass}.
2805
2806This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2807in the reload pass.
2808
2809The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2810in words.
2811@end deftypefn
2812
d37d6c0b 2813@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
889fd92b 2814A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2815of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2816
2817This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2818the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2819should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2820@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2821
2822This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2823in the reload pass.
d37d6c0b 2824@end defmac
889fd92b 2825
d37d6c0b 2826@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
22aae821 2827If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2828a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
889fd92b 2829
e94743fa 2830For example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2831floating-point registers on Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
889fd92b 2832Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
ae567dd2 2833does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
897118e8 2834register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2835as below:
c5af420e 2836
a0ecd6b1 2837@smallexample
22aae821 2838#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2839 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2840 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
a0ecd6b1 2841@end smallexample
e94743fa 2842
2843Even if storing from a register in mode @var{to} would be valid,
2844if both @var{from} and @code{raw_reg_mode} for @var{class} are wider
2845than @code{word_mode}, then we must prevent @var{to} narrowing the
2846mode. This happens when the middle-end assumes that it can load
2847or store pieces of an @var{N}-word pseudo, and that the pseudo will
2848eventually be allocated to @var{N} @code{word_mode} hard registers.
2849Failure to prevent this kind of mode change will result in the
2850entire @code{raw_reg_mode} being modified instead of the partial
2851value that the middle-end intended.
2852
d37d6c0b 2853@end defmac
889fd92b 2854
ef704984 2855@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t}, @var{reg_class_t})
20c3c7fc 2856A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from
ef704984 2857 allocno and best class calculated by IRA.
20c3c7fc 2858
2859 The default version of this target hook always returns given class.
2860@end deftypefn
2861
c6a6cdaa 2862@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
979ff17b 2863A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. The default version of this target hook returns true. New ports should use LRA, and existing ports are encouraged to convert.
c6a6cdaa 2864@end deftypefn
2865
2866@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2867A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2868@end deftypefn
2869
4a2ca8f3 2870@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2871A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2872@end deftypefn
2873
c6a6cdaa 2874@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2875A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2876@end deftypefn
2877
f4447329 2878@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst})
2879A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't
2880substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during
2881register allocation.
2882The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2883On most machines, this default should be used. For generally
2884machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such
2885as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2886@end deftypefn
2887
968ba45e 2888@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{disp}, rtx *@var{offset}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2889A target hook which returns @code{true} if *@var{disp} is
2890legitimezed to valid address displacement with subtracting *@var{offset}
2891at memory mode @var{mode}.
2892The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2893This hook will benefit machines with limited base plus displacement
2894addressing.
2895@end deftypefn
2896
3754d046 2897@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode})
c6a6cdaa 2898This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2899@end deftypefn
2900
c3bd02b3 2901@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDITIONAL_ALLOCNO_CLASS_P (reg_class_t)
2902This hook should return @code{true} if given class of registers should be an allocno class in any way. Usually RA uses only one register class from all classes containing the same register set. In some complicated cases, you need to have two or more such classes as allocno ones for RA correct work. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{false} for all inputs.
2903@end deftypefn
2904
7cae74a7 2905@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
17f446a0 2906This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2907@end deftypefn
2908
d83668f4 2909@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPUTE_PRESSURE_CLASSES (enum reg_class *@var{pressure_classes})
2910A target hook which lets a backend compute the set of pressure classes to be used by those optimization passes which take register pressure into account, as opposed to letting IRA compute them. It returns the number of register classes stored in the array @var{pressure_classes}.
2911@end deftypefn
2912
889fd92b 2913@node Stack and Calling
2914@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2915@cindex calling conventions
2916
2917@c prevent bad page break with this line
2918This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2919
2920@menu
2921* Frame Layout::
de624aa8 2922* Exception Handling::
071cd279 2923* Stack Checking::
889fd92b 2924* Frame Registers::
2925* Elimination::
2926* Stack Arguments::
2927* Register Arguments::
2928* Scalar Return::
2929* Aggregate Return::
2930* Caller Saves::
2931* Function Entry::
2932* Profiling::
e3c541f0 2933* Tail Calls::
9be10499 2934* Shrink-wrapping separate components::
f1a0edff 2935* Stack Smashing Protection::
e9eaaa6a 2936* Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
889fd92b 2937@end menu
2938
2939@node Frame Layout
2940@subsection Basic Stack Layout
2941@cindex stack frame layout
2942@cindex frame layout
2943
2944@c prevent bad page break with this line
2945Here is the basic stack layout.
2946
d37d6c0b 2947@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2b785411 2948Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2949pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise.
d37d6c0b 2950@end defmac
889fd92b 2951
d37d6c0b 2952@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
07c143fb 2953This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2954on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
78f1b1cd 2955@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
07c143fb 2956
2957The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2958and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2959the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2960to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2961space for the next item on the stack.
2962
2963The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2b785411 2964true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
07c143fb 2965which is often wrong.
d37d6c0b 2966@end defmac
07c143fb 2967
d37d6c0b 2968@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3ce7ff97 2969Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
d28d5017 2970are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
d37d6c0b 2971@end defmac
889fd92b 2972
d37d6c0b 2973@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
889fd92b 2974Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2975addresses on the stack.
d37d6c0b 2976@end defmac
889fd92b 2977
d37d6c0b 2978@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
889fd92b 2979Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2980
2981If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2982subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2983Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2984value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2985@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2986@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
d37d6c0b 2987@end defmac
889fd92b 2988
d37d6c0b 2989@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
256f9b65 2990Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
bf02170c 2991The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
256f9b65 2992
bf02170c 2993On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
256f9b65 2994is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2995alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2996stack alignment and do it in the backend.
d37d6c0b 2997@end defmac
256f9b65 2998
d37d6c0b 2999@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
889fd92b 3000Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3001outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3002zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3003
3004If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3005the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
d37d6c0b 3006@end defmac
889fd92b 3007
d37d6c0b 3008@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
889fd92b 3009Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3010address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3011function.
3012
3013If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3014the first argument's address.
d37d6c0b 3015@end defmac
889fd92b 3016
d37d6c0b 3017@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
889fd92b 3018Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3019on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3020
3021The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3022length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3023machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
d37d6c0b 3024@end defmac
889fd92b 3025
869d0ef0 3026@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3027A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
b215c058 3028stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
e3e15c50 3029@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3030default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
b215c058 3031elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
e3e15c50 3032@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
869d0ef0 3033@end defmac
3034
d37d6c0b 3035@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
889fd92b 3036A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3037frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3038@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3039itself.
3040
3041If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3042of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3043address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
d37d6c0b 3044@end defmac
889fd92b 3045
d37d6c0b 3046@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3dd01ce6 3047A C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
889fd92b 3048setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
7800959d 3049on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
5e300ff6 3050before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3dd01ce6 3051define this macro. The default is to do nothing.
d37d6c0b 3052@end defmac
5e300ff6 3053
53edaaf2 3054@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
e3e026e8 3055This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
5e300ff6 3056the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3057The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
e3e026e8 3058machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
5e300ff6 3059@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
e3e026e8 3060@end deftypefn
889fd92b 3061
3a69c60c 3062@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3063A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3064address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3065of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3066You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3067as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3068@end defmac
3069
d37d6c0b 3070@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
889fd92b 3071A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
071cd279 3072address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3073the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3074frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
32497dec 3075@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero.
889fd92b 3076
0dbd1c74 3077The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
d458baea 3078@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
0dbd1c74 3079determine the return address of other frames.
d37d6c0b 3080@end defmac
0dbd1c74 3081
d37d6c0b 3082@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
32497dec 3083Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular
3084stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack
3085frame. The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
d37d6c0b 3086@end defmac
071cd279 3087
d37d6c0b 3088@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
071cd279 3089A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3090incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3091prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3092value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3093the stack.
3094
3095You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3096debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3097
220d204b 3098If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
70c2c81c 3099@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
d37d6c0b 3100@end defmac
220d204b 3101
c49ad9ef 3102@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
894b8fd9 3103A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
dd5e1e90 3104number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3105must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3106be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3107
3108This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3109general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3110frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3111over time.
c49ad9ef 3112@end defmac
3113
223e8e29 3114@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3115A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3116number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3117only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3118someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3119terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3120@end defmac
3121
d15ee1a5 3122@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3123This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3124contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3125info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3126@smallexample
7a5a9c54 3127(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
d15ee1a5 3128@end smallexample
3129and
3130@smallexample
7a5a9c54 3131(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
d15ee1a5 3132@end smallexample
3133to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3134the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3135the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3136@end deftypefn
3137
d37d6c0b 3138@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
071cd279 3139A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3140from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3141frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3142the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3143previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3144
ec37ccb4 3145You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3146debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
d37d6c0b 3147@end defmac
ec37ccb4 3148
d37d6c0b 3149@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
ec37ccb4 3150A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3151from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3b0848a2 3152final value should coincide with that calculated by
ec37ccb4 3153@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3154during virtual register instantiation.
3155
c9b5e4ec 3156The default value for this macro is
3157@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
220d204b 3158which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
b848cb8e 3159immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3160some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3161and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
220d204b 3162
b848cb8e 3163You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
220d204b 3164want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3165DWARF 2.
d37d6c0b 3166@end defmac
397f1574 3167
da72c083 3168@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3169If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3170in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
554f2707 3171The final value should coincide with that calculated by
da72c083 3172@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3173
3174Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
b215c058 3175via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
da72c083 3176variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
191ec5a2 3177defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
da72c083 3178based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3179of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3180should be defined.
3181@end defmac
3182
89fa767a 3183@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3184If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3185in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3186in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3187may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3188@end defmac
3189
de624aa8 3190@node Exception Handling
3191@subsection Exception Handling Support
3192@cindex exception handling
3193
d37d6c0b 3194@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
df4b504c 3195A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3196data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3197@var{N} registers are usable.
3198
3199The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3200handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3201should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3202but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
32032 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3204
3205You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3206handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
d37d6c0b 3207@end defmac
df4b504c 3208
d37d6c0b 3209@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
df4b504c 3210A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3211to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3212This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3213It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3214
3b0848a2 3215Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
df4b504c 3216untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3217
cd4e2223 3218Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
894b8fd9 3219by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3220this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3221stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3222this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
cd4e2223 3223that provided by DWARF 2.
d37d6c0b 3224@end defmac
df4b504c 3225
d37d6c0b 3226@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
df4b504c 3227A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3b0848a2 3228to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
df4b504c 3229return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3230
3231Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3b0848a2 3232return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3233address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
df4b504c 3234the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
894b8fd9 3235frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3236been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
cd4e2223 3237target call frame.
df4b504c 3238
3239Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3240address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3241the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3242
3243If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3244define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
d37d6c0b 3245@end defmac
df4b504c 3246
b9b226b0 3247@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3248If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3249to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3250exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3251using it to return to the exception handler.
3252@end defmac
3253
d37d6c0b 3254@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
ad5818ae 3255This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3256handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3257that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3258and so may be read-only.
3259
70c2c81c 3260@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3261@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
ad5818ae 3262The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3263as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3264
77f71523 3265If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
ad5818ae 3266represented directly.
d37d6c0b 3267@end defmac
ad5818ae 3268
d37d6c0b 3269@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
ad5818ae 3270This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3271to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3272Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3273be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3274
70c2c81c 3275This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3276handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3277of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
ad5818ae 3278to be emitted.
d37d6c0b 3279@end defmac
ad5818ae 3280
aebd6cb6 3281@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
6daf3d3a 3282This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
de624aa8 3283code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3284available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3285through signal frames.
3286
81f13185 3287This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3288@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3289@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
de624aa8 3290@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3291for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
81f13185 3292the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3293save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3294evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3295the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
f55a8237 3296
3297For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3298@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
d37d6c0b 3299@end defmac
071cd279 3300
792f6e73 3301@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3302This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3303call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3304usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3305
c07f27fd 3306This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3307@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
792f6e73 3308@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3309for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3310@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3311be updated in @var{fs}.
3312@end defmac
3313
2f9fc8ef 3314@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3315A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3316info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3317linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3318@end defmac
3319
071cd279 3320@node Stack Checking
3321@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3322
4852b829 3323GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3324stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3325three ways:
071cd279 3326
3327@enumerate
3328@item
e8e57187 3329If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
4852b829 3330will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3331at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3332other special processing.
071cd279 3333
3334@item
4852b829 3335If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3336@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3337that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3338static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3339in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3340stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3341approach below.
071cd279 3342
3343@item
e8e57187 3344If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
071cd279 3345``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3346@end enumerate
3347
4852b829 3348If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3349GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3350@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3351dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
071cd279 3352
d37d6c0b 3353@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
071cd279 3354A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3b0848a2 3355machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
24833e1a 3356is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
4852b829 3357checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3358value of this macro is zero.
3359@end defmac
3360
3361@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3362A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3363in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3364like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3365approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
d37d6c0b 3366@end defmac
071cd279 3367
42982f3e 3368@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3369An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3370instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3371define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3372the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3373of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
d37d6c0b 3374@end defmac
071cd279 3375
42982f3e 3376@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3377An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3378when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3379contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3380thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3381is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3382default value of this macro is zero.
3383@end defmac
3384
d37d6c0b 3385@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
7ee609a5 3386The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
5ee1325b 3387languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 4KB/8KB
7ee609a5 3388with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
5ee1325b 33898KB/12KB with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for most
3390architectures and operating systems.
d37d6c0b 3391@end defmac
071cd279 3392
4852b829 3393The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3394nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3395in the opposite case.
3396
d37d6c0b 3397@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
e8e57187 3398The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
071cd279 3399instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3400stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
e8e57187 3401checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3402default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
071cd279 3403systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
d37d6c0b 3404@end defmac
071cd279 3405
d37d6c0b 3406@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
e8e57187 3407GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
071cd279 3408represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3409space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3410You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3411use the default of four words.
d37d6c0b 3412@end defmac
071cd279 3413
d37d6c0b 3414@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
e8e57187 3415The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
071cd279 3416fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
8ae77b3c 3417@option{-fstack-check}.
e8e57187 3418GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
071cd279 3419normally not need to override that default.
d37d6c0b 3420@end defmac
889fd92b 3421
3422@need 2000
3423@node Frame Registers
3424@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3425
3426@c prevent bad page break with this line
3427This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3428
d37d6c0b 3429@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
889fd92b 3430The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3431fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3432the hardware determines which register this is.
d37d6c0b 3433@end defmac
889fd92b 3434
d37d6c0b 3435@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
889fd92b 3436The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3437access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3438hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3439choose any register you wish for this purpose.
d37d6c0b 3440@end defmac
889fd92b 3441
d37d6c0b 3442@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
889fd92b 3443On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3444offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3445allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3446between these two locations). On those machines, define
3447@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3448be used internally until the offset is known, and define
da2b9be0 3449@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
889fd92b 3450used for the frame pointer.
3451
3452You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3453is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3454the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3455completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3456definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3457@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3458or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3459
3460Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3461@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
d37d6c0b 3462@end defmac
889fd92b 3463
d37d6c0b 3464@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
889fd92b 3465The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3466the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3467frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3468register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3469wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3470pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3471@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3472(@pxref{Elimination}).
d37d6c0b 3473@end defmac
889fd92b 3474
5ae82d58 3475@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3476Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3477@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3478the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3479== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3480definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3481@end defmac
3482
3483@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3484Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3485@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3486same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3487ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3488definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3489@end defmac
3490
d37d6c0b 3491@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
889fd92b 3492The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3493access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3494machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3495pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3496to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3497@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3498
3499Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3500address from the stack.
d37d6c0b 3501@end defmac
889fd92b 3502
d37d6c0b 3503@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3504@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
889fd92b 3505Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3506register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3507function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3508number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3509these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
f36eeacd 3510not be defined.
889fd92b 3511
3512The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3513
3514If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
974b8df6 3515defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
d37d6c0b 3516@end defmac
ba7065a9 3517
8d54d6a0 3518@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p})
82c7907c 3519This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3520targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3521nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3522attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3523those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3524
3525The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
974b8df6 3526
3527If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3528provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3529Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3530from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3531will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3532@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3533@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3534@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3535The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3536@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3537to refer to those items.
82c7907c 3538@end deftypefn
3539
d37d6c0b 3540@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
ba7065a9 3541This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3542saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3543DWARF2 exception handling.
3544
3545Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3546exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3547extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3548in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3549used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3550routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3551registers that are not call-saved.
3552
3553If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3554@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
d37d6c0b 3555@end defmac
ba7065a9 3556
d37d6c0b 3557@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
ba7065a9 3558
3559This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3560for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3561
3562If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3563@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
d37d6c0b 3564@end defmac
ba7065a9 3565
d37d6c0b 3566@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
e92aec9e 3567
3568Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3569is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
c472286c 3570Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
e92aec9e 3571column number to use instead.
d37d6c0b 3572@end defmac
889fd92b 3573
4eeb8b5d 3574@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3575
3576Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3577used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
ef8d967c 3578debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
4eeb8b5d 3579should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3580@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3581
3582@end defmac
3583
3584@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3585
3586Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
ef8d967c 3587that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
4eeb8b5d 3588should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
9e7454d0 3589.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
4eeb8b5d 3590return @code{@var{regno}}.
3591
3592@end defmac
3593
e451a093 3594@defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3595
3596Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3597@code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3598target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3599default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3600
3601@end defmac
3602
3603@defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3604
3605Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3606context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3607it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3608defined and 0 otherwise.
3609
3610@end defmac
3611
889fd92b 3612@node Elimination
3613@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3614
3615@c prevent bad page break with this line
3616This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3617
5a1c68c3 3618@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3619This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3620a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3621value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
889fd92b 3622
5a1c68c3 3623This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
a4efa7dc 3624according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3625constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3626to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3627Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3628pointer.
889fd92b 3629
3630In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3631without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3632automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
acbc95ac 3633@code{targetm.frame_pointer_required} returns. You don't need to worry about
f36eeacd 3634them.
889fd92b 3635
3636In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3637register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3638fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
a4efa7dc 3639
5a1c68c3 3640Default return value is @code{false}.
3641@end deftypefn
889fd92b 3642
d37d6c0b 3643@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
acbc95ac 3644This macro specifies a table of register pairs used to eliminate
3645unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.
889fd92b 3646
3647The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3648of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3649
3650On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3651the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3652must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3653replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3654depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3655
3656In this case, you might specify:
a0ecd6b1 3657@smallexample
889fd92b 3658#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3659@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3660 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3661 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
a0ecd6b1 3662@end smallexample
889fd92b 3663
3664Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3665specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
d37d6c0b 3666@end defmac
889fd92b 3667
53edaaf2 3668@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
acbc95ac 3669This target hook should return @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
53edaaf2 3670try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
acbc95ac 3671@var{to_reg}. This target hook will usually be @code{true}, since most of the
3672cases preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
889fd92b 3673knows about.
0e841940 3674
cd90919d 3675Default return value is @code{true}.
3676@end deftypefn
889fd92b 3677
d37d6c0b 3678@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
acbc95ac 3679This macro returns the initial difference between the specified pair
3680of registers. The value would be computed from information
3681such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3682registers @code{df_regs_ever_live_p} and @code{call_used_regs}.
d37d6c0b 3683@end defmac
889fd92b 3684
5e9a50c1 3685@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_COMPUTE_FRAME_LAYOUT (void)
3686This target hook is called once each time the frame layout needs to be
3687recalculated. The calculations can be cached by the target and can then
3688be used by @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET} instead of re-computing the
3689layout on every invocation of that hook. This is particularly useful
3690for targets that have an expensive frame layout function. Implementing
3691this callback is optional.
3692@end deftypefn
3693
889fd92b 3694@node Stack Arguments
3695@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3696@cindex arguments on stack
3697@cindex stack arguments
3698
3699The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3700on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3701control passing certain arguments in registers.
3702
53edaaf2 3703@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
45550790 3704This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3705prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3706passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3707cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3708The default is to not promote prototypes.
3709@end deftypefn
889fd92b 3710
d37d6c0b 3711@defmac PUSH_ARGS
71d6ad5e 3712A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
4448f543 3713outgoing arguments.
3714If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3715That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3716allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
70c2c81c 3717it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
d37d6c0b 3718@end defmac
4448f543 3719
8c69f6fb 3720@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3721A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3722last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3723defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3724and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3725@end defmac
3726
d37d6c0b 3727@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
889fd92b 3728A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3729stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
889fd92b 3730
3731On some machines, the definition
3732
a0ecd6b1 3733@smallexample
889fd92b 3734#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
a0ecd6b1 3735@end smallexample
889fd92b 3736
3737@noindent
3738will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3739to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3740alignment. Then the definition should be
3741
a0ecd6b1 3742@smallexample
889fd92b 3743#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
a0ecd6b1 3744@end smallexample
c6e790c5 3745
2f05705b 3746If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
d37d6c0b 3747@end defmac
889fd92b 3748
81e483dd 3749@findex outgoing_args_size
3750@findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
d37d6c0b 3751@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
71d6ad5e 3752A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
81e483dd 3753will be computed and placed into
3754@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
889fd92b 3755onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3756increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3757
4448f543 3758Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
889fd92b 3759is not proper.
d37d6c0b 3760@end defmac
889fd92b 3761
d37d6c0b 3762@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
889fd92b 3763Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3764allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3765registers.
3766
3767The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
be2828ce 3768arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
e8e57187 3769which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
fa20f865 3770The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3771of the function.
889fd92b 3772
3773This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3774machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3775which.
d37d6c0b 3776@end defmac
889fd92b 3777@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3778@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3779
02114c95 3780@defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3781Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3782Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3783is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3784can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3785@end defmac
3786
22c61100 3787@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3788Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3789caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3790when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3791if the function called is a library function.
889fd92b 3792
3793If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3794whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
81e483dd 3795@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
d37d6c0b 3796@end defmac
889fd92b 3797
d37d6c0b 3798@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
889fd92b 3799Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3800stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3801@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3802@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3803
3804Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3805stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3806suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3807stack in its natural location.
d37d6c0b 3808@end defmac
889fd92b 3809
fe0b4016 3810@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
f5bc28da 3811This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3812a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3813and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
889fd92b 3814
3815@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3816the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3817@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
e3c541f0 3818From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
889fd92b 3819
3820@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3821describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3822@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3823From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3824arguments (if known).
3825
071cd279 3826When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
889fd92b 3827will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3828you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3829by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3830a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3831in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3832
fe0b4016 3833@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
889fd92b 3834stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3835argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3836
6c842310 3837On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
fe0b4016 3838of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
889fd92b 3839calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3840the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3841convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3842arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3843nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3844@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3845number of arguments.
f5bc28da 3846@end deftypefn
87e19636 3847
d37d6c0b 3848@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
87e19636 3849A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3850pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3851when compiling a function call.
3852
3853@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3854have been accumulated.
3855
3856On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3857that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3858that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3859call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3860appropriate.
d37d6c0b 3861@end defmac
889fd92b 3862
3863@node Register Arguments
3864@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3865@cindex arguments in registers
3866@cindex registers arguments
3867
3868This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3869types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3870the stack.
3871
3754d046 3872@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
81bcd36c 3873Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3874register and if so, which register.
889fd92b 3875
81bcd36c 3876The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
889fd92b 3877arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3878the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3879(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
81bcd36c 3880which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3881nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3882function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3883syntax error has previously occurred.
889fd92b 3884
81bcd36c 3885The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3886register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3887on the stack.
889fd92b 3888
058a1b7a 3889The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is
3890passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks
3891should be used to store or load argument in such case. See
3892@code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}
3893for more information.
3894
0858e3a2 3895The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
889fd92b 3896used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
2ecf0503 3897@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
889fd92b 3898@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
65f736d8 3899describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3900@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3901register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3902register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3903second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3904the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3b0848a2 3905As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
e9412714 3906RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3907argument is also stored on the stack.
889fd92b 3908
81bcd36c 3909The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
a9f4b9f7 3910VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3911pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3912
889fd92b 3913@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
81bcd36c 3914The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3915machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3916cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3917done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3918@var{named} is @code{false}.
3919
3920@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3921@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
0336f0f0 3922You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
889fd92b 3923in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3924type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
81bcd36c 3925is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
889fd92b 3926argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3927defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3928a register.
81bcd36c 3929@end deftypefn
889fd92b 3930
3754d046 3931@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
0336f0f0 3932This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3933solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
04144be4 3934definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3935documentation.
0336f0f0 3936@end deftypefn
04144be4 3937
3754d046 3938@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
e9f82fd3 3939Define this hook if the caller and callee on the target have different
3940views of where arguments are passed. Also define this hook if there are
3941functions that are never directly called, but are invoked by the hardware
3942and which have nonstandard calling conventions.
889fd92b 3943
e9f82fd3 3944In this case @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
81bcd36c 3945which the caller passes the value, and
3946@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
3947fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
3948arrive.
889fd92b 3949
e9f82fd3 3950@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} can also return arbitrary address
3951computation using hard register, which can be forced into a register,
3952so that it can be used to pass special arguments.
3953
81bcd36c 3954If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
3955@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
3956@end deftypefn
889fd92b 3957
a9d8ab38 3958@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void)
3959This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created
3960for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.
3961@end deftypefn
3962
3963@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void)
3964Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.
3965This hook is called at the start of register allocation.
3966@end deftypefn
3967
3754d046 3968@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
f054eb3c 3969This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
3970argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
889fd92b 3971arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3972pushed on the stack.
3973
3974On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3975registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
f054eb3c 3976first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
889fd92b 3977on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3978structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3979in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
f054eb3c 3980compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
889fd92b 3981
81bcd36c 3982@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
889fd92b 3983register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
81bcd36c 3984@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
f054eb3c 3985@end deftypefn
889fd92b 3986
3754d046 3987@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
9e7454d0 3988This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
b981d932 3989position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
9e7454d0 3990predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
b981d932 3991passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
3992
3993If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
889fd92b 3994pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3995The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3996to that type.
b981d932 3997@end deftypefn
889fd92b 3998
3754d046 3999@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
13f08ee7 4000The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4001known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4002function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4003by the caller.
4004
8ff30ff6 4005For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
13f08ee7 4006determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4007not be generated.
4008
4009The default version of this hook always returns false.
4010@end deftypefn
889fd92b 4011
d37d6c0b 4012@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
81bcd36c 4013A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4014of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4015target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4016of bytes of argument so far.
889fd92b 4017
4018There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4019arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4020variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4021arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4022@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4023should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
d37d6c0b 4024@end defmac
889fd92b 4025
d3feb168 4026@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4027If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4028function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4029created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4030reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4031If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4032@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4033@end defmac
4034
30c70355 4035@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
d37d6c0b 4036A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4037@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4038variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4039is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4040the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4041For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4042declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4043@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
30c70355 4044being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4045arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4046parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
01e3cadf 4047@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
889fd92b 4048
4049When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4050@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4051contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4052an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4053macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4054never both of them at once.
d37d6c0b 4055@end defmac
889fd92b 4056
d37d6c0b 4057@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
e1efd914 4058Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4059it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4060@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4061is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
40620)} is used instead.
d37d6c0b 4063@end defmac
e1efd914 4064
d37d6c0b 4065@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
889fd92b 4066Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4067finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4068undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4069
4070The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
0858e3a2 4071with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
889fd92b 4072argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4073@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4074@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4075@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
d37d6c0b 4076@end defmac
889fd92b 4077
3754d046 4078@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
81bcd36c 4079This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4080advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4081@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4082the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4083argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
889fd92b 4084
81bcd36c 4085This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
889fd92b 4086on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4087used for arguments without any special help.
81bcd36c 4088@end deftypefn
889fd92b 4089
b704e80f 4090@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4091If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4092offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4093which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4094slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4095top.
4096@end defmac
4097
d37d6c0b 4098@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
889fd92b 4099If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4100to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4101@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4102@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4103
17bfc2bc 4104The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4105target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4106always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
889fd92b 4107
4108This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4109For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4110big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4111constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
d37d6c0b 4112@end defmac
889fd92b 4113
d37d6c0b 4114@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
3b0848a2 4115If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4116implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
726e2588 4117next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4118controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4119arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
d37d6c0b 4120@end defmac
726e2588 4121
5f4cd670 4122@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4123Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4124memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4125macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4126machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4127@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4128registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4129a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4130required.
4131@end defmac
4132
3754d046 4133@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
b59688ee 4134This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
bd99ba64 4135with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4136@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4137@end deftypefn
889fd92b 4138
3754d046 4139@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
17bfc2bc 4140Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4141which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4142return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4143value.
4144@end deftypefn
4145
d37d6c0b 4146@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
889fd92b 4147A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4148register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4149@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4150the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4151used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4152stack.
d37d6c0b 4153@end defmac
562c48ae 4154
53edaaf2 4155@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
92d40bc4 4156This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4157as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4158arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4159to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4160AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4161registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4162point register.
4163
4164The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4165false.
4166@end deftypefn
915e81b8 4167
bdc5306d 4168@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4169This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4170The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4171@end deftypefn
4172
303ece6c 4173@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
acd6f472 4174This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4175to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4176variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
303ece6c 4177to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
acd6f472 4178variable.
303ece6c 4179The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
acd6f472 4180this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4181internal type.
4182If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4183Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4184macro to iterate through all types.
4185@end deftypefn
4186
5f57a8b1 4187@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4188This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4189@var{fndecl}.
4190The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4191@end deftypefn
4192
4193@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4194This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4195type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4196@code{NULL_TREE}.
4197@end deftypefn
4198
53edaaf2 4199@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
e0eca1fa 4200This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4201@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4202arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4203@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
e0eca1fa 4204@end deftypefn
4205
f77c4496 4206@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (scalar_int_mode @var{mode})
64bdda86 4207Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4208with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4209hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4210@end deftypefn
4211
b3e7c666 4212@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref *@var{ref})
be97d4b6 4213Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4214@end deftypefn
4215
8aec1ebb 4216@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (scalar_mode @var{mode})
b2aef146 4217Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4218insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4219considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4220must work.
4221
4222The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4223required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4224Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4225code in @file{optabs.c}.
4226@end deftypefn
4227
3754d046 4228@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
9e7454d0 4229Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4230insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4231must have move patterns for this mode.
4232@end deftypefn
4233
3754d046 4234@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
13d3ceb9 4235Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4236of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4237Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4238and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4239
4240One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4241that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4242has operations like:
4243
4244@smallexample
4245int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4246@end smallexample
4247
4248where the return type is defined as:
4249
4250@smallexample
4251typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4252@{
4253 int8x8_t val[3];
4254@} int8x8x3_t;
4255@end smallexample
4256
4257If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4258@code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4259@code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4260@end deftypefn
4261
d067137d 4262@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (scalar_float_mode @var{mode})
d5957f0d 4263Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4264floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4265@code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this
4266hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4267@code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4268@end deftypefn
4269
a15787d8 4270@deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_scalar_float_mode TARGET_FLOATN_MODE (int @var{n}, bool @var{extended})
82c85aba 4271Define this to return the machine mode to use for the type
4272@code{_Float@var{n}}, if @var{extended} is false, or the type
a15787d8 4273@code{_Float@var{n}x}, if @var{extended} is true. If such a type is not
4274supported, return @code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}. The default version of
4275this hook returns @code{SFmode} for @code{_Float32}, @code{DFmode} for
82c85aba 4276@code{_Float64} and @code{_Float32x} and @code{TFmode} for
4277@code{_Float128}, if those modes exist and satisfy the requirements for
4278those types and pass @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} and
4279@code{TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}; for @code{_Float64x}, it
4280returns the first of @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} that exists and
4281satisfies the same requirements; for other types, it returns
a15787d8 4282@code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}. The hook is only called for values
4283of @var{n} and @var{extended} that are valid according to
4284ISO/IEC TS 18661-3:2015; that is, @var{n} is one of 32, 64, 128, or,
4285if @var{extended} is false, 16 or greater than 128 and a multiple of 32.
82c85aba 4286@end deftypefn
4287
3754d046 4288@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
ed5527ca 4289Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4290small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4291@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4292in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4293In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4294for any mode.
4295
4296On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4297insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4298to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4299if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4300insn.
4301
4302Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4303in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4304the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4305classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4306registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4307registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4308SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4309strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4310machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4311
b59688ee 4312The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
ed5527ca 4313safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4314unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4315that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4316to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4317of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4318@end deftypefn
4319
889fd92b 4320@node Scalar Return
4321@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4322@cindex return values in registers
4323@cindex values, returned by functions
4324@cindex scalars, returned as values
4325
4326This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4327values---values that can fit in registers.
4328
53edaaf2 4329@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
62419968 4330
4331Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4332returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
68576faf 4333representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
62419968 4334representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4335function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4336compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4337Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4338a function returns a value.
4339
4340On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4341(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4342place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4343@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4344The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
81bcd36c 4345multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
2d329930 4346@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4347location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4348the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4349that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4350port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4351@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
62419968 4352
4353If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4354the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4355@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
889fd92b 4356
4357If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4358node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4359pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4360convention for specific functions when all their calls are
f36eeacd 4361known.
889fd92b 4362
62419968 4363Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4364which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4365the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4366different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4367
4368@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4369aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
8a0686b1 4370@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
62419968 4371@end deftypefn
4372
4373@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4374This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4375a new target instead.
d37d6c0b 4376@end defmac
889fd92b 4377
d37d6c0b 4378@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
889fd92b 4379A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
838bd0ed 4380function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
889fd92b 4381
4382Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4383support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4384specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4385compiled.
d37d6c0b 4386@end defmac
889fd92b 4387
3754d046 4388@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
578d1295 4389Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
15b474a2 4390function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
578d1295 4391
4392The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
15b474a2 4393library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
578d1295 4394representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4395
4396If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4397@end deftypefn
4398
d37d6c0b 4399@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
889fd92b 4400A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4401register in which the values of called function may come back.
4402
4403A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4404second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4405recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4406suffices:
4407
a0ecd6b1 4408@smallexample
889fd92b 4409#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
a0ecd6b1 4410@end smallexample
889fd92b 4411
4412If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4413function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4414should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
e1ce1485 4415
4416This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4417for a new target instead.
d37d6c0b 4418@end defmac
889fd92b 4419
e1ce1485 4420@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4421A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4422register in which the values of called function may come back.
4423
4424A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4425second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4426recognized by this target hook.
4427
4428If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4429function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4430should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4431
4432If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4433@end deftypefn
4434
d37d6c0b 4435@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
889fd92b 4436Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4437need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4438saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
d37d6c0b 4439@end defmac
889fd92b 4440
809140f3 4441@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG
4442Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address
4443is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also
4444arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal
67cf9b55 4445pointer return value. Define this to true if that behavior is
809140f3 4446undesirable on your target.
4447@end deftypevr
4448
53edaaf2 4449@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
2c8ff1ed 4450This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4451at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4452padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4453is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4454
62419968 4455Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4456be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4457or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44584-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4459@code{SImode} rtx.
2c8ff1ed 4460@end deftypefn
4461
889fd92b 4462@node Aggregate Return
4463@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4464@cindex aggregates as return values
4465@cindex large return values
4466@cindex returning aggregate values
4467@cindex structure value address
4468
4469When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
62419968 4470cases), the value is not returned according to
4471@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4472caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4473should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4474address}.
889fd92b 4475
4476This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4477memory.
4478
53edaaf2 4479@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
45550790 4480This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4481function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4482Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4483will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4484libcalls.
889fd92b 4485
4486Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
45550790 4487by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
889fd92b 4488takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
45550790 4489possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
889fd92b 4490definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4491values, and 0 otherwise.
4492
45550790 4493Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
889fd92b 4494be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4495to indicate this.
45550790 4496@end deftypefn
889fd92b 4497
d37d6c0b 4498@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
889fd92b 4499Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4500in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
0858e3a2 4501only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
889fd92b 4502If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
e920c3d4 4503and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4504target hook.
889fd92b 4505
4506If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
d37d6c0b 4507@end defmac
889fd92b 4508
45550790 4509@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4510This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4511address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4512passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
10ec06d3 4513be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4514hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4515argument.
889fd92b 4516
889fd92b 4517On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4518is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4519caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4520be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
d8c09ceb 4521@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4522the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
45550790 4523the caller.
889fd92b 4524
9ca2c29a 4525If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
d8c09ceb 4526stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4527@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
6db57367 4528structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
d8c09ceb 4529to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
45550790 4530@end deftypefn
889fd92b 4531
d37d6c0b 4532@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
889fd92b 4533Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4534for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4535the address of a static variable containing the value.
4536
4537Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4538pass an address to the subroutine.
4539
8ae77b3c 4540This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4541nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
d37d6c0b 4542@end defmac
889fd92b 4543
3754d046 4544@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4bac51c9 4545This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4546@end deftypefn
4547
3754d046 4548@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4bac51c9 4549This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4550@end deftypefn
4551
889fd92b 4552@node Caller Saves
4553@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4554
e8e57187 4555If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
889fd92b 4556makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4557must live across calls.
4558
d37d6c0b 4559@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
a3a64825 4560A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4561of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4562@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4563returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4564will select the smallest suitable mode.
d37d6c0b 4565@end defmac
889fd92b 4566
4567@node Function Entry
4568@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4569@cindex function entry and exit
4570@cindex prologue
4571@cindex epilogue
4572
4573This section describes the macros that output function entry
4574(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4575
e6c4532a 4576@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_PRINT_PATCHABLE_FUNCTION_ENTRY (FILE *@var{file}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{patch_area_size}, bool @var{record_p})
4577Generate a patchable area at the function start, consisting of
4578@var{patch_area_size} NOP instructions. If the target supports named
4579sections and if @var{record_p} is true, insert a pointer to the current
4580location in the table of patchable functions. The default implementation
4581of the hook places the table of pointers in the special section named
4582@code{__patchable_function_entries}.
4583@end deftypefn
4584
718e6d56 4585@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
17d9b0c3 4586If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
889fd92b 4587function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4588initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4589saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
718e6d56 4590local variables. @var{file} is a stdio stream to which the assembler
4591code should be output.
889fd92b 4592
4593The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4594macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4595
4596@findex regs_ever_live
4597To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4598@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4599@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4600prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
17d9b0c3 4601call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
889fd92b 4602@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4603
4604On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4605not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4606they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4607appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4608registers are used in the function.
4609
4610@findex frame_pointer_needed
4611On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4612function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4613pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4614frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4615@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4616time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4617
4618The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4619required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4620listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4621order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4622stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4623the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4624for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4625compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4626or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4627need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
17d9b0c3 4628@end deftypefn
4629
11ff5d0d 4630@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4631If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4632prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4633emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4634emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4635@end deftypefn
4636
4637@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4638If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4639epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4640emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4641emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4642@end deftypefn
4643
718e6d56 4644@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
17d9b0c3 4645If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4646function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4647registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4648called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
718e6d56 4649same argument as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
17d9b0c3 4650registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4651@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4652
4653On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4654of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4655instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4656@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4657
4658Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4659@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4660switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4661define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4662target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4663condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4664
4665On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4666function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4667two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4668is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4669@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4670a function that needs a frame pointer.
4671
4672Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4673@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4674The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4675function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4676
4677On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4678others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4679given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4680number of arguments.
4681
81e483dd 4682@findex pops_args
4683@findex crtl->args.pops_args
17d9b0c3 4684Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4685functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
f2779bd1 4686needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4687function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4688@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
17d9b0c3 4689@end deftypefn
4690
889fd92b 4691@itemize @bullet
4692@item
81e483dd 4693@findex pretend_args_size
4694@findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4695A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
889fd92b 4696uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4697stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4698if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4699arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4700yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4701region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4702registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
7ccc713a 4703features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
889fd92b 4704
4705@item
4706An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4707The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4708the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4709machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4710in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4711a save area.
4712
4713@item
4714A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4715boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4716this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4717save area closer to the top of the stack.
4718
4719@item
4720@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4721Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
81e483dd 4722@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
889fd92b 4723argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4724@end itemize
4725
d37d6c0b 4726@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
889fd92b 4727Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4728instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4729pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
13c5e7bf 4730adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4731default is 0.
889fd92b 4732
4733Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4734frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4735stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4736compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
d37d6c0b 4737@end defmac
889fd92b 4738
d37d6c0b 4739@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
3387c533 4740Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
889fd92b 4741used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
ab4f0a13 4742pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
d37d6c0b 4743@end defmac
889fd92b 4744
d37d6c0b 4745@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
1c6bdf07 4746Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4747used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4748on entry to an exception edge.
d37d6c0b 4749@end defmac
1c6bdf07 4750
3c20fe9b 4751@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
c6933ba6 4752A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
889fd92b 4753function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4754inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4755adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4756the real function.
4757
4758First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4759contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4760contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4761in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
0858f8a2 4762e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
889fd92b 4763all other incoming arguments.
4764
3c20fe9b 4765Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4766made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4767adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4768
4769@smallexample
4770p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4771@end smallexample
4772
4773After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
889fd92b 4774@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4775not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4776return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4777
4778The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4779the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
17d9b0c3 4780of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4781and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
889fd92b 4782
4783The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4784have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4785some targets, but probably not.
4786
071cd279 4787If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
8e5fcce7 4788front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
071cd279 4789@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4790not support varargs.
c6933ba6 4791@end deftypefn
4792
53edaaf2 4793@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
3c20fe9b 4794A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4795to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4796arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4797generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4798previously exposed.
c6933ba6 4799@end deftypefn
889fd92b 4800
4801@node Profiling
4802@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4803@cindex profiling, code generation
4804
4805These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4806
d37d6c0b 4807@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
889fd92b 4808A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4809assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
889fd92b 4810
4811@findex mcount
f712b9ff 4812The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
0858e3a2 4813your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
f712b9ff 4814compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4815compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4816
4817Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4818variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4819@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4820the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
d37d6c0b 4821@end defmac
f712b9ff 4822
d37d6c0b 4823@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
104d9861 4824A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4825code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4826not support profiling.
d37d6c0b 4827@end defmac
104d9861 4828
d37d6c0b 4829@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
fda0d99d 4830Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4831@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4832allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4833implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4834@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
d37d6c0b 4835@end defmac
889fd92b 4836
d37d6c0b 4837@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
889fd92b 4838Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4839the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
d37d6c0b 4840@end defmac
889fd92b 4841
d44f2f7c 4842@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4843This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4844@end deftypefn
4845
e3c541f0 4846@node Tail Calls
4847@subsection Permitting tail calls
4848@cindex tail calls
82cac298 4849
805e22b2 4850@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
88eebb49 4851True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
805e22b2 4852call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4853or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
cf247f9c 4854
4855It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4856tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
805e22b2 4857during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
3b0848a2 4858as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
805e22b2 4859``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4860may vary greatly between different architectures.
4861@end deftypefn
cf247f9c 4862
53edaaf2 4863@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
fcf2ad9f 4864Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4865function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4866cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4867registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4868TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4869FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4870@end deftypefn
4871
2e851bb8 4872@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4873This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4874@end deftypefn
4875
08c6cbd2 4876@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4877True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4878@end deftypefn
4879
9be10499 4880@node Shrink-wrapping separate components
4881@subsection Shrink-wrapping separate components
4882@cindex shrink-wrapping separate components
4883
4884The prologue may perform a variety of target dependent tasks such as
4885saving callee-saved registers, saving the return address, aligning the
4886stack, creating a stack frame, initializing the PIC register, setting
4887up the static chain, etc.
4888
4889On some targets some of these tasks may be independent of others and
4890thus may be shrink-wrapped separately. These independent tasks are
4891referred to as components and are handled generically by the target
4892independent parts of GCC.
4893
4894Using the following hooks those prologue or epilogue components can be
4895shrink-wrapped separately, so that the initialization (and possibly
4896teardown) those components do is not done as frequently on execution
4897paths where this would unnecessary.
4898
4899What exactly those components are is up to the target code; the generic
4900code treats them abstractly, as a bit in an @code{sbitmap}. These
4901@code{sbitmap}s are allocated by the @code{shrink_wrap.get_separate_components}
4902and @code{shrink_wrap.components_for_bb} hooks, and deallocated by the
4903generic code.
4904
4905@deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_GET_SEPARATE_COMPONENTS (void)
4906This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
4907components that can be separately shrink-wrapped in the current function.
4908Return @code{NULL} if the current function should not get any separate
4909shrink-wrapping.
4910Don't define this hook if it would always return @code{NULL}.
4911If it is defined, the other hooks in this group have to be defined as well.
4912@end deftypefn
4913
4914@deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_COMPONENTS_FOR_BB (basic_block)
4915This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
4916components where either the prologue component has to be executed before
4917the @code{basic_block}, or the epilogue component after it, or both.
4918@end deftypefn
4919
4920@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_DISQUALIFY_COMPONENTS (sbitmap @var{components}, edge @var{e}, sbitmap @var{edge_components}, bool @var{is_prologue})
4921This hook should clear the bits in the @var{components} bitmap for those
4922components in @var{edge_components} that the target cannot handle on edge
4923@var{e}, where @var{is_prologue} says if this is for a prologue or an
4924epilogue instead.
4925@end deftypefn
4926
4927@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_PROLOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
4928Emit prologue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
4929@end deftypefn
4930
4931@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_EPILOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
4932Emit epilogue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
4933@end deftypefn
4934
4935@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_SET_HANDLED_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
4936Mark the components in the parameter as handled, so that the
4937@code{prologue} and @code{epilogue} named patterns know to ignore those
4938components. The target code should not hang on to the @code{sbitmap}, it
4939will be deleted after this call.
4940@end deftypefn
4941
f1a0edff 4942@node Stack Smashing Protection
4943@subsection Stack smashing protection
4944@cindex stack smashing protection
4945
4946@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4947This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
b215c058 4948for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
f1a0edff 4949runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4950that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4951variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4952
4953The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4954@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4955@end deftypefn
4956
4957@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
5a13cc45 4958This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
f1a0edff 4959stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4960involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4961
4962The default version of this hook invokes a function called
b215c058 4963@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
f1a0edff 4964normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4965@end deftypefn
4966
783f362b 4967@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_RUNTIME_ENABLED_P (void)
4968Returns true if the target wants GCC's default stack protect runtime support, otherwise return false. The default implementation always returns true.
4969@end deftypefn
4970
218e3e4e 4971@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
b213bf24 4972Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
48b14f50 4973@end deftypefn
4974
e9eaaa6a 4975@node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
4976@subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
4977@cindex miscellaneous register hooks
4978
4979@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
9e203f5c 4980Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
4981clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
4982That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
4983linker (e.g. stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
4984modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
4985in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
4986The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook
fcf56aaf 4987is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.
e9eaaa6a 4988@end deftypevr
4989
889fd92b 4990@node Varargs
4991@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4992@cindex varargs implementation
4993
70c2c81c 4994GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4995@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
889fd92b 4996on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4997varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4998conditionals to include it.
4999
70c2c81c 5000ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
889fd92b 5001the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
5002implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
78b1f616 5003to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
889fd92b 5004@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
5005supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5006
5007However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5008the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5009below.
5010
d37d6c0b 5011@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
889fd92b 5012Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
78b1f616 5013that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
889fd92b 5014versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
dfabcc74 5015you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
889fd92b 5016
5017On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
b074b706 5018control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5019other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5020found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
889fd92b 5021
5022Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5023beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5024@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5025This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5026to use them for its own purposes.
5027@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5028@c 10feb93
d37d6c0b 5029@end defmac
889fd92b 5030
d37d6c0b 5031@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
f739ab33 5032This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
71d6ad5e 5033argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
889fd92b 5034returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5035argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5036fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5037verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5038of the current function.
d37d6c0b 5039@end defmac
889fd92b 5040
d37d6c0b 5041@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
889fd92b 5042Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5043passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5044has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5045specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5046with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5047
5048@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5049considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5050kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5051
5052The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5053interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
d37d6c0b 5054@end defmac
889fd92b 5055
5056These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5057
45550790 5058@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5059If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5060@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5061beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5062return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5063to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5064@end deftypefn
889fd92b 5065
3754d046 5066@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
45550790 5067This target hook offers an alternative to using
5068@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5069@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5070register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5071have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5072use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5073pass all their arguments on the stack.
889fd92b 5074
45550790 5075The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
3387c533 5076structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
889fd92b 5077named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5078last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5079
45550790 5080The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5081argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5082store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5083variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5084store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5085frame.
889fd92b 5086
5087Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5088compile time without knowing their data types,
45550790 5089@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5090have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5091for all data types.
889fd92b 5092
5093If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5094arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5095happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
45550790 5096end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
889fd92b 5097not generate any instructions in this case.
45550790 5098@end deftypefn
889fd92b 5099
39cba157 5100@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
45550790 5101Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
997d68fe 5102argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
889fd92b 5103
81bcd36c 5104This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
45550790 5105is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5106@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5107arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
cb5ebb12 5108but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
45550790 5109then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5110except the last are treated as named.
997d68fe 5111
53edaaf2 5112You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
45550790 5113@end deftypefn
8b823204 5114
53597a55 5115@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree})
5116While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once
5117for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by
5118@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just
5119before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the
5120function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is
5121@code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is
5122invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.
5123This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument
5124registers if a target needs it.
5125For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}
5126passed instead of an argument register.
5127Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5128@end deftypefn
5129
5130@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void)
5131This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,
5132just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It
5133signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just
5134emitted call are now no longer in use.
5135Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5136@end deftypefn
5137
39cba157 5138@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
8b823204 5139If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
45550790 5140@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5141@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5142defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
dfabcc74 5143@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
45550790 5144Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5145@end deftypefn
889fd92b 5146
058a1b7a 5147@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5148This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of
5149@var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5150bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5151memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from
5152memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5153constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5154should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.
5155@end deftypefn
5156
5157@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5158This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of
5159@var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5160@var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5161memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in
5162memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5163constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5164should be used to store @var{bounds}.
5165@end deftypefn
5166
5167@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot})
5168This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds
5169returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding
5170loaded bounds.
5171@end deftypefn
5172
5173@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds})
5174This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}
5175returned by function call into @var{slot}.
5176@end deftypefn
5177
5178@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_CHKP_FUNCTION_VALUE_BOUNDS (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
5179Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
5180returns bounds for returned pointers. Arguments meaning is similar to
5181@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE}.
5182@end deftypefn
5183
582adad1 5184@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARG_BOUNDS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
058a1b7a 5185Use it to store bounds for anonymous register arguments stored
5186into the stack. Arguments meaning is similar to
5187@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}.
5188@end deftypefn
5189
889fd92b 5190@node Trampolines
5191@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5192@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5193@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5194
5195A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5196when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5197the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
e8e57187 5198tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
889fd92b 5199trampoline.
5200
5201The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5202address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5203the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5204two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5205exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5206machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5207two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5208operands.
5209
5210The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5211parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5212immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5213simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5214proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5215may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5216separately.
5217
82c7907c 5218@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5219This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5220on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5221the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5222label---the label is taken care of automatically.
889fd92b 5223
82c7907c 5224If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5225for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
889fd92b 5226code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5227to generate it on the spot.
82c7907c 5228@end deftypefn
889fd92b 5229
d37d6c0b 5230@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
2f14b1f9 5231Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5232(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
d37d6c0b 5233@end defmac
889fd92b 5234
d37d6c0b 5235@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
889fd92b 5236A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
d37d6c0b 5237@end defmac
889fd92b 5238
d37d6c0b 5239@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
889fd92b 5240Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5241
82c7907c 5242If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
889fd92b 5243is used for aligning trampolines.
d37d6c0b 5244@end defmac
889fd92b 5245
82c7907c 5246@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5247This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5248@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5249is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
889fd92b 5250RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5251when it is called.
5252
82c7907c 5253If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5254first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5255from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
15b474a2 5256Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
82c7907c 5257trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5258to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
3f27e198 5259
82c7907c 5260If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
15b474a2 5261enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
82c7907c 5262initializing the trampoline proper.
5263@end deftypefn
5264
5265@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5266This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5267the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5268memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5269the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5270address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5271be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5272If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5273@end deftypefn
889fd92b 5274
a27e3913 5275@deftypevr {Target Hook} int TARGET_CUSTOM_FUNCTION_DESCRIPTORS
5276This hook should be defined to a power of 2 if the target will benefit
5277from the use of custom descriptors for nested functions instead of the
5278standard trampolines. Such descriptors are created at run time on the
5279stack and made up of data only, but they are non-standard so the generated
5280code must be prepared to deal with them. This hook should be defined to 0
5281if the target uses function descriptors for its standard calling sequence,
5282like for example HP-PA or IA-64. Using descriptors for nested functions
5283eliminates the need for trampolines that reside on the stack and require
5284it to be made executable.
5285
5286The value of the macro is used to parameterize the run-time identification
5287scheme implemented to distinguish descriptors from function addresses: it
5288gives the number of bytes by which their address is misaligned compared
5289with function addresses. The value of 1 will generally work, unless it is
5290already reserved by the target for another purpose, like for example on ARM.
5291@end deftypevr
5292
889fd92b 5293Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5294separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5295fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5296jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5297
5298Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5299the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5300make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5301subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5302latter makes initialization faster.
5303
5304To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
6fa2a5a8 5305the following macro.
889fd92b 5306
d37d6c0b 5307@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
889fd92b 5308If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
6fa2a5a8 5309cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5310typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5311@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
d37d6c0b 5312@end defmac
889fd92b 5313
5314To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5315you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5316cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5317beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5318its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5319
d37d6c0b 5320@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
889fd92b 5321Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5322work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
0858e3a2 5323which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
889fd92b 5324@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5325
5326If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5327C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5328special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5329statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5330global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5331special assembler code.
d37d6c0b 5332@end defmac
889fd92b 5333
5334@node Library Calls
5335@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5336@cindex library subroutine names
5337@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5338
5339@c prevent bad page break with this line
5340Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5341
d37d6c0b 5342@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
856ba90e 5343This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5344expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
ef8d967c 5345provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
856ba90e 5346are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
d37d6c0b 5347@end defmac
856ba90e 5348
f2f543a3 5349@findex set_optab_libfunc
5f77f12a 5350@findex init_one_libfunc
f2f543a3 5351@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5352This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5353existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5354@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5355@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5356library routines.
889fd92b 5357
f2f543a3 5358The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5359@end deftypefn
6f71c48d 5360
f308a9b2 5361@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5362If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5363underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5364instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5365currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5366is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5367@code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5368@end deftypevr
5369
a16f837d 5370@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
f2f543a3 5371This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5372implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5373mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5374return a tristate.
5375
5376GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5377comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5378don't need to define this macro.
5379@end defmac
5380
30e9913f 5381@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5382This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5383functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5384operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5385and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
4f0d4720 5386If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
01e3cadf 5387@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
30e9913f 5388in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5389@end defmac
5390
b214253d 5391@defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5392This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5393instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5394make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5395division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5396make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5397@end defmac
5398
889fd92b 5399@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
d37d6c0b 5400@findex matherr
5401@defmac TARGET_EDOM
889fd92b 5402The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
e8e57187 5403expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
889fd92b 5404deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5405@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5406system.
5407
5408If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5409domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5410error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5411there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5412that @code{matherr} is used normally.
d37d6c0b 5413@end defmac
889fd92b 5414
889fd92b 5415@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
d37d6c0b 5416@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
889fd92b 5417Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5418refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5419@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5420macro, a reasonable default is used.
d37d6c0b 5421@end defmac
889fd92b 5422
30f690e0 5423@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5424This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5425@var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.
5426@end deftypefn
164951a6 5427
d37d6c0b 5428@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
3f3d5ad4 5429Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5430by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5431and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5432This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5433the NeXT runtime installed.
5434
5435If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5436will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5437selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5438
5439In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5440scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
d37d6c0b 5441@end defmac
889fd92b 5442
5443@node Addressing Modes
5444@section Addressing Modes
5445@cindex addressing modes
5446
5447@c prevent bad page break with this line
5448This is about addressing modes.
5449
d37d6c0b 5450@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5451@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5452@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5453@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
f45856ef 5454A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
48a3cfe4 5455pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
d37d6c0b 5456@end defmac
889fd92b 5457
d37d6c0b 5458@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5459@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
f45856ef 5460A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
48a3cfe4 5461post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5462the size of the memory operand.
d37d6c0b 5463@end defmac
dddae62f 5464
d37d6c0b 5465@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5466@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
f45856ef 5467A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
48a3cfe4 5468post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
d37d6c0b 5469@end defmac
dddae62f 5470
d37d6c0b 5471@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
889fd92b 5472A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
24833e1a 5473is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5474@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5475is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
15b474a2 5476constant addresses are supported.
d37d6c0b 5477@end defmac
889fd92b 5478
d37d6c0b 5479@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5480@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5481accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5482known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5483expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5484@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5485@end defmac
889fd92b 5486
d37d6c0b 5487@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
889fd92b 5488A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5489memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
fd50b071 5490the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
889fd92b 5491accept.
d37d6c0b 5492@end defmac
889fd92b 5493
3754d046 5494@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
fd50b071 5495A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5496address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
889fd92b 5497
fd50b071 5498Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5f77f12a 5499non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
fd50b071 5500desired by the caller.
889fd92b 5501
fd50b071 5502The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5503that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5504considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5505kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5506must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5507up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5508register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5509if the array holds @code{-1}.
889fd92b 5510
5511The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5512accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5513register is required.
5514
889fd92b 5515Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5516and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5517constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5518specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5519recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5520
5521Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5522sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5523@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5524naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5525be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5526
7811991d 5527@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
889fd92b 5528On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5529the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
7811991d 5530target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5531into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
889fd92b 5532@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5533@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5534Format}.
fd50b071 5535
5536@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5537Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5538this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5539has this syntax:
5540
5541@example
5542#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5543@end example
5544
5545@noindent
5546and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5547address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
db5bbd5b 5548
5549@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5550Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5551macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5552@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5553that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5554
fd50b071 5555Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5556files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5557@end deftypefn
889fd92b 5558
e9ff93b1 5559@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5560A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5561character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5562letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
fd50b071 5563@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
e9ff93b1 5564support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5565semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5566preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5567@code{'m'} constraint.
5568@end defmac
5569
d37d6c0b 5570@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
b206e51d 5571A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5572or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
2e984a7a 5573can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5574@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
15750b1e 5575
5576It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5577that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5578
5579The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
0858e3a2 5580a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
d37d6c0b 5581@end defmac
15750b1e 5582
3754d046 5583@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode})
41e3a0c7 5584This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5585operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5586address.
889fd92b 5587
5588@findex break_out_memory_refs
5589@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5590and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5591@var{x}.
5592
41e3a0c7 5593The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
889fd92b 5594@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
41e3a0c7 5595should return the new @var{x}.
889fd92b 5596
7bc65ea7 5597It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5598with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5599The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5600the target supports only emulated TLS, it
41e3a0c7 5601is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5602a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5603strategy can generate better code.
5604@end deftypefn
889fd92b 5605
d37d6c0b 5606@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
f64bc32a 5607A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5608that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5609@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5610It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
3b0848a2 5611performance reasons.
f64bc32a 5612
5613For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5614reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5615registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5616processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5617needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
70c2c81c 5618@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
f64bc32a 5619generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5620be shared.
5621
73a69254 5622@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5623to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5624and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5625of reload internals.
f64bc32a 5626
861aa17f 5627@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5628previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5629then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5630
f64bc32a 5631@findex push_reload
73a69254 5632The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5633need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5634suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
f64bc32a 5635
73a69254 5636The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
f64bc32a 5637@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5638should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5639This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5640@code{push_reload}.
5641
73a69254 5642@findex strict_memory_address_p
5643The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5644the address has become legitimate.
5645
f64bc32a 5646@findex copy_rtx
5647If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
284bef0e 5648this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
f64bc32a 5649single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
8e5fcce7 5650top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
f64bc32a 5651It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5652address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
d37d6c0b 5653@end defmac
f64bc32a 5654
4e27ffd0 5655@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5656This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5657space @var{addrspace} can have
98e22cb6 5658different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5659reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5660but not others.
5661
5662Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5663effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5664of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5665addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5666
5667You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5668
5669The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5670@end deftypefn
5671
3754d046 5672@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
ca316360 5673This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5674@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5675@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5676
5677The default definition returns true.
5678@end deftypefn
889fd92b 5679
b0a62515 5680@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5681This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5682@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5683macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5684references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5685addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5686the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5687into their original form.
5688@end deftypefn
202e7097 5689
5690@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5691This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5692debug sections.
5693@end deftypefn
b0a62515 5694
3754d046 5695@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
bdc5306d 5696This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
7d7d7bd2 5697should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5698of @var{x}.
5699
5700The default version of this hook returns false.
bdc5306d 5701
5702The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5703deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5704from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5705holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5706of TLS symbols for various targets.
5707@end deftypefn
5708
3754d046 5709@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
f2d0e9f1 5710This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5711be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5712of @var{x}.
5713
5714The default version returns false for all constants.
5715@end deftypefn
5716
80d4c05f 5717@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5718This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5719be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5720
5721The default version returns true for all decls.
5722@end deftypefn
5723
4cfd27a5 5724@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (tree @var{fndecl})
5725This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements the
5726reciprocal of the machine-specific builtin function @var{fndecl}, or
851c1b0c 5727@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
e174638f 5728@end deftypefn
5729
f61467c8 5730@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5731This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5732address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
b215c058 5733used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
f61467c8 5734@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5735
284bef0e 5736The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
f61467c8 5737@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5738the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5739@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5740two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5741@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5742the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5743from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
b215c058 5744@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5745@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
f61467c8 5746@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5747
5748If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5749to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5750use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5751@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
b215c058 5752should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
f61467c8 5753described above.
5754If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5755the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
1cbc9316 5756log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
f61467c8 5757@end deftypefn
5758
0822b158 5759@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
559093aa 5760Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
15b474a2 5761For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
0822b158 5762misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
7c5f74ee 5763@end deftypefn
5764
5765@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
33a82fb9 5766Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given scalar type @var{type}. @var{is_packed} is false if the scalar access using @var{type} is known to be naturally aligned.
7c5f74ee 5767@end deftypefn
5768
3754d046 5769@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (machine_mode, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
8b962d7a 5770Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
7c5f74ee 5771@end deftypefn
5772
011d9d16 5773@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
9d8bf4aa 5774This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
011d9d16 5775input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
7c5f74ee 5776The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5777specifies how the conversion is to be applied
9d8bf4aa 5778(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5779
5780If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5781@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5782conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5783@end deftypefn
5784
b6c464fe 5785@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
31ac7341 5786This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
b6c464fe 5787vectorized variant of the function with the @code{combined_fn} code
31ac7341 5788@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
b6c464fe 5789The return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5790@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5791@end deftypefn
5792
5793@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MD_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5794This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5795vectorized variant of target built-in function @code{fndecl}. The
31ac7341 5796return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5797@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
22c2f6bd 5798@end deftypefn
5799
3754d046 5800@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
c6b19c5f 5801This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5802store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5803parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5804the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5805parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5806@end deftypefn
5807
4c1a1be2 5808@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (scalar_mode @var{mode})
b24d851f 5809This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5810mode @var{mode}. The default is
5811equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
2101edf2 5812transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5813@end deftypefn
5814
421b11b1 5815@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5816This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5817after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5818mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5819The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5820@end deftypefn
5821
1f137e6d 5822@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE (unsigned @var{nunits}, unsigned @var{length})
5823This hook returns mode to be used for a mask to be used for a vector
5824of specified @var{length} with @var{nunits} elements. By default an integer
5825vector mode of a proper size is returned.
5826@end deftypefn
5827
4db2b577 5828@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
f97dec81 5829This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
4db2b577 5830@end deftypefn
5831
f97dec81 5832@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5833This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
4db2b577 5834@end deftypefn
5835
f97dec81 5836@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5837This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
4db2b577 5838@end deftypefn
5839
5840@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5841This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5842@end deftypefn
5843
16dfb112 5844@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5845Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5846is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5847the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5848The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5849loads.
5850@end deftypefn
5851
0bd6d857 5852@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_SCATTER (const_tree @var{vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5853Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation. @var{vectype}
5854is the vector type of the store and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5855the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5856The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize scatter
5857stores.
5858@end deftypefn
5859
d09768a4 5860@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
5861This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
5862fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
5863@var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
5864The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
5865or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
5866@end deftypefn
5867
5868@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5869This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
5870to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
5871@end deftypefn
5872
5873@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5874This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
5875in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
5876usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
5877to use it.
5878@end deftypefn
5879
7fce8768 5880@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMT_VF (void)
5881Return number of threads in SIMT thread group on the target.
5882@end deftypefn
5883
c25f1934 5884@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_VALIDATE_DIMS (tree @var{decl}, int *@var{dims}, int @var{fn_level})
0bb0f256 5885This hook should check the launch dimensions provided for an OpenACC
5886compute region, or routine. Defaulted values are represented as -1
948eee2f 5887and non-constant values as 0. The @var{fn_level} is negative for the
0bb0f256 5888function corresponding to the compute region. For a routine is is the
948eee2f 5889outermost level at which partitioned execution may be spawned. The hook
5890should verify non-default values. If DECL is NULL, global defaults
5891are being validated and unspecified defaults should be filled in.
5892Diagnostics should be issued as appropriate. Return
0bb0f256 5893true, if changes have been made. You must override this hook to
5894provide dimensions larger than 1.
5895@end deftypefn
5896
e1037942 5897@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_GOACC_DIM_LIMIT (int @var{axis})
5898This hook should return the maximum size of a particular dimension,
5899or zero if unbounded.
5900@end deftypefn
5901
c25f1934 5902@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_FORK_JOIN (gcall *@var{call}, const int *@var{dims}, bool @var{is_fork})
cbba99a0 5903This hook can be used to convert IFN_GOACC_FORK and IFN_GOACC_JOIN
5904function calls to target-specific gimple, or indicate whether they
5905should be retained. It is executed during the oacc_device_lower pass.
5906It should return true, if the call should be retained. It should
5907return false, if it is to be deleted (either because target-specific
5908gimple has been inserted before it, or there is no need for it).
5909The default hook returns false, if there are no RTL expanders for them.
c25f1934 5910@end deftypefn
5911
641a0fa1 5912@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_GOACC_REDUCTION (gcall *@var{call})
5913This hook is used by the oacc_transform pass to expand calls to the
5914@var{GOACC_REDUCTION} internal function, into a sequence of gimple
5915instructions. @var{call} is gimple statement containing the call to
5916the function. This hook removes statement @var{call} after the
5917expanded sequence has been inserted. This hook is also responsible
5918for allocating any storage for reductions when necessary.
5919@end deftypefn
5920
f2d0e9f1 5921@node Anchored Addresses
5922@section Anchored Addresses
5923@cindex anchored addresses
5924@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5925
5926GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5927For example, if we have:
5928
5929@smallexample
5930static int a, b, c;
5931int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5932@end smallexample
5933
5934the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5935addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5936it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5937the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5938be something like:
5939
5940@smallexample
5941int foo (void)
5942@{
5943 register int *xr = &x;
5944 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5945@}
5946@end smallexample
5947
5948(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5949``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5950
5951The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5952in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5953section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5954or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5955
48a84cee 5956@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
f2d0e9f1 5957The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5958On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5959applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5960for every mode. The default value is 0.
48a84cee 5961@end deftypevr
f2d0e9f1 5962
48a84cee 5963@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
f2d0e9f1 5964Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5965offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5966value is 0.
48a84cee 5967@end deftypevr
f2d0e9f1 5968
5969@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5970Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5971@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5972The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5973of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5974
5975If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5976it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5977If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5978is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5979@end deftypefn
5980
ddc6a57f 5981@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
f2d0e9f1 5982Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
6617cbc1 5983@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
f2d0e9f1 5984@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5985
5986The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5987intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5988or target-specific sections.
5989@end deftypefn
5990
889fd92b 5991@node Condition Code
5992@section Condition Code Status
5993@cindex condition code status
5994
74f4459c 5995The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5996two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5997
5998The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5999(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
6000clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
6001register representation, which provides better schedulability for
6002architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
6003most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
6004most RISC machines.
6005
6006The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
77cb85b2 6007the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition
6008and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping
6009arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
6010Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally,
6011the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
6012
6013These restrictions can prevent important
74f4459c 6014optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
6015is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
6016three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
6017scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
6018separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
6019
6020For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
6021represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
6022condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
6023condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
6024or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
6025Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
6026that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
6027
6028Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
6029specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
6030interested in most macros in this section.
6031
6032@menu
6033* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
6034* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
74f4459c 6035@end menu
6036
6037@node CC0 Condition Codes
6038@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
6039@findex cc0
889fd92b 6040
6041@findex cc_status
6042The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
6043describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
6044the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
6045variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
6046currently based, and several standard flags.
6047
6048Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
6049description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
6050information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
6051
d37d6c0b 6052@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
889fd92b 6053C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
6054component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
6055
6056This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
d37d6c0b 6057@end defmac
889fd92b 6058
d37d6c0b 6059@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
889fd92b 6060A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
6061The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
6062the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
6063define this macro to initialize it.
6064
6065This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
d37d6c0b 6066@end defmac
889fd92b 6067
d37d6c0b 6068@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
889fd92b 6069A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
6070appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
6071this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
6072code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
6073set @code{(cc0)}.
6074
6075This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6076
6077If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
6078other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
6079invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
6080reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
6081registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
6082@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
6083insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
6084based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
6085value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
6086this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
6087@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
6088@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
6089condition code value.
6090
6091The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
6092with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
6093@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
6094constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
6095insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
6096@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
6097@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
6098
6099A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
6100that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
6101@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
6102two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
d37d6c0b 6103@end defmac
889fd92b 6104
74f4459c 6105@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
6106@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
6107@findex CCmode
6108@findex MODE_CC
6109
d37d6c0b 6110@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
74f4459c 6111On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
6112than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
6113code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
6114when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
6115bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6116branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
6117this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6118record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
6119also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
6120unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6121
6122If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6123@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6124a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
6125have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6126by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6127be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6128the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6129
6130@smallexample
6131(define_insn ""
94ec1a50 6132 [(set (reg:CCNZ 0)
6133 (compare:CCNZ
74f4459c 6134 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6135 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6136 (const_int 0)))]
6137 ""
6138 "@dots{}")
6139@end smallexample
6140
6141@noindent
94ec1a50 6142together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CCNZmode}
74f4459c 6143for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
889fd92b 6144
6145@smallexample
6146#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
123f1406 6147 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6148 ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE) \
6149 ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode) \
6150 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6151 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \
94ec1a50 6152 ? CCNZmode : CCmode))
889fd92b 6153@end smallexample
6154
74f4459c 6155Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6156were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6157this section.
6158
15460c97 6159You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6160in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
d37d6c0b 6161@end defmac
889fd92b 6162
f8e3aa87 6163@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
3387c533 6164On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
889fd92b 6165convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6166does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6167comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6168
d5065e6e 6169On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6170@var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6171are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
6172@var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6173allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6174in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
6175allowed to swap operands in that case.
889fd92b 6176
e8e57187 6177GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
889fd92b 6178valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6179@file{md} file.
6180
d5065e6e 6181You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6182comparison code or operands.
6183@end deftypefn
889fd92b 6184
d37d6c0b 6185@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
889fd92b 6186A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6187comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6188can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6189then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6190
6191You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6192floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
7800959d 6193For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
123f1406 6194inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}:
889fd92b 6195
6196@smallexample
123f1406 6197#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \
6198 ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode)
889fd92b 6199@end smallexample
d37d6c0b 6200@end defmac
889fd92b 6201
d37d6c0b 6202@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
59112222 6203A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6204comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6205@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6206machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6207instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
123f1406 6208freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones. Then definition may look
59112222 6209like:
6210
6211@smallexample
6212#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
8e5fcce7 6213 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
59112222 6214 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6215@end smallexample
d37d6c0b 6216@end defmac
59112222 6217
35c16056 6218@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
124ac4e4 6219On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6220register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6221regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6222hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6223small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6224to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6225arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6226When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
35c16056 6227integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
124ac4e4 6228@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6229
6230The default version of this hook returns false.
6231@end deftypefn
6232
3754d046 6233@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2})
124ac4e4 6234On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6235@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6236validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6237target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6238both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6239return @code{VOIDmode}.
6240
6241The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6242same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6243returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6244@end deftypefn
6245
3b64e9e1 6246@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
6247If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
6248@end deftypevr
6249
889fd92b 6250@node Costs
6251@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6252@cindex costs of instructions
6253@cindex relative costs
6254@cindex speed of instructions
6255
6256These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6257on the target machine.
6258
d37d6c0b 6259@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
0ac516dc 6260A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6261register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6262expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6263value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6264that.
889fd92b 6265
6266It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6267same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6268registers if they are not general registers.
6269
6270If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6271hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6272classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6273constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6274allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6275if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
e6078fbb 6276
6277These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6278@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
d37d6c0b 6279@end defmac
889fd92b 6280
3754d046 6281@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
e6078fbb 6282This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6283from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6284are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6285A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6286that.
6287
6288It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6289same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6290registers if they are not general registers.
6291
6292If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6293hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6294classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6295constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6296allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6297if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6298
6299The default version of this function returns 2.
6300@end deftypefn
6301
d37d6c0b 6302@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
3afef759 6303A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6304register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
f45856ef 6305is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
4c685015 6306is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6307registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6308should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6309
e8e57187 6310If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
3398e91d 6311the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
4c685015 6312needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6313between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6314more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6315reflect the actual cost of the move.
6316
e8e57187 6317GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
4c685015 6318secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6319a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6320secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
63214 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6322value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6323are the same as to this macro.
251a613e 6324
6325These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6326@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
d37d6c0b 6327@end defmac
3afef759 6328
3754d046 6329@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
251a613e 6330This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
9de204fa 6331between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
251a613e 6332if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
e6078fbb 6333This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6334If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6335registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
251a613e 6336
6337If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6338the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6339needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
9de204fa 6340between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
251a613e 6341more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6342reflect the actual cost of the move.
6343
6344GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6345secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6346a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6347secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
63484 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6349value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6350are the same as to this target hook.
6351@end deftypefn
6352
4a9d7ef7 6353@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
b56a5220 6354A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6355the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6356@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6357for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6358optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6359true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6360@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
d37d6c0b 6361@end defmac
889fd92b 6362
6363Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
e8e57187 6364but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
889fd92b 6365ordinarily expect.
6366
d37d6c0b 6367@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
889fd92b 6368Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
0858f8a2 6369than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
889fd92b 6370faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6371require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6372between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6373
6374When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6375finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6376load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6377faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6378may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6379other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
d37d6c0b 6380@end defmac
889fd92b 6381
d37d6c0b 6382@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
f94d02c6 6383Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6384@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6385than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
d7671d77 6386handler. This macro is invoked only for unaligned accesses, i.e. when
6387@code{@var{alignment} < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}.
889fd92b 6388
f45856ef 6389When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6390@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
889fd92b 6391moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
f45856ef 6392Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
889fd92b 6393cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6394
a36bcaf4 6395If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
f45856ef 6396this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6397@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
d37d6c0b 6398@end defmac
889fd92b 6399
24833e1a 6400@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
36670375 6401The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
7014838c 6402which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
889fd92b 6403string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6404make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6405
7014838c 6406Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6407@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6408the number of such sequences.
36670375 6409
24833e1a 6410The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6411optimized for speed rather than size.
6412
889fd92b 6413If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
d37d6c0b 6414@end defmac
889fd92b 6415
89da42b6 6416@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p})
0ec3791c 6417GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between
6418two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example
6419when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure
6420implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move
6421insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the
6422@code{movmem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit
6423unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.
6424
6425This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a
6426given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}
6427infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.
6428Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage
6429units.
6430
6431The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},
3e346f54 6432@code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES} or
6433@code{COMPARE_BY_PIECES}. These describe the type of memory operation
6434under consideration.
0ec3791c 6435
6436The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being
6437optimized for speed rather than size.
6438
6439Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation
6440for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the
6441@code{movmem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{movmem} or
6442@code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of
6443insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of
6444the body of the memory operation.
6445
6446Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase
6447in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a
6448move would be greater than that of a library call.
6449@end deftypefn
6450
3e346f54 6451@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_BY_PIECES_BRANCH_RATIO (machine_mode @var{mode})
6452When expanding a block comparison in MODE, gcc can try to reduce the
6453number of branches at the expense of more memory operations. This hook
6454allows the target to override the default choice. It should return the
6455factor by which branches should be reduced over the plain expansion with
6456one comparison per @var{mode}-sized piece. A port can also prevent a
6457particular mode from being used for block comparisons by returning a
6458negative number from this hook.
6459@end deftypefn
6460
d37d6c0b 6461@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
53bd09ab 6462A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
c14ad648 6463a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
d37d6c0b 6464@end defmac
53bd09ab 6465
3e346f54 6466@defmac STORE_MAX_PIECES
6467A C expression used by @code{store_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6468a store used to memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}, or two times
6469the size of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, whichever is smaller.
6470@end defmac
6471
6472@defmac COMPARE_MAX_PIECES
6473A C expression used by @code{compare_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6474a load or store used to compare memory is. Defaults to
6475@code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}.
6476@end defmac
6477
24833e1a 6478@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
310d3ec9 6479The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6480of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6481or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6482eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6483
24833e1a 6484The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6485optimized for speed rather than size.
6486
310d3ec9 6487If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
d37d6c0b 6488@end defmac
310d3ec9 6489
24833e1a 6490@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
4b297e2e 6491The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6492of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
15b474a2 6493a block set insn or a library call.
4b297e2e 6494Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6495eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6496
24833e1a 6497The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6498optimized for speed rather than size.
6499
4b297e2e 6500If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6501@end defmac
6502
d37d6c0b 6503@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
c14ad648 6504A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6505thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6506@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
d37d6c0b 6507@end defmac
c14ad648 6508
d37d6c0b 6509@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
c14ad648 6510A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6511thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6512@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
d37d6c0b 6513@end defmac
53bd09ab 6514
d37d6c0b 6515@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
c14ad648 6516A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6517thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6518@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
d37d6c0b 6519@end defmac
c14ad648 6520
d37d6c0b 6521@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
c14ad648 6522A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6523thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6524@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
d37d6c0b 6525@end defmac
53bd09ab 6526
d37d6c0b 6527@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
c14ad648 6528A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6529thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6530@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
d37d6c0b 6531@end defmac
c14ad648 6532
d37d6c0b 6533@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
8e5fcce7 6534A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
c14ad648 6535thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6536@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
d37d6c0b 6537@end defmac
53bd09ab 6538
d37d6c0b 6539@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
c14ad648 6540This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6541thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6542@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
d37d6c0b 6543@end defmac
c14ad648 6544
d37d6c0b 6545@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
c14ad648 6546This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6547thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6548@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
d37d6c0b 6549@end defmac
53bd09ab 6550
d37d6c0b 6551@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
93516111 6552Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant
889fd92b 6553function address than to call an address kept in a register.
d37d6c0b 6554@end defmac
889fd92b 6555
802c6441 6556@defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6557Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6558@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6559@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6560@end defmac
6561
acdfe9e0 6562@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P (int @var{op}, machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2}, optimization_type @var{opt_type})
6563Return true if the optimizers should use optab @var{op} with
6564modes @var{mode1} and @var{mode2} for optimization type @var{opt_type}.
6565The optab is known to have an associated @file{.md} instruction
6566whose C condition is true. @var{mode2} is only meaningful for conversion
6567optabs; for direct optabs it is a copy of @var{mode1}.
6568
6569For example, when called with @var{op} equal to @code{rint_optab} and
6570@var{mode1} equal to @code{DFmode}, the hook should say whether the
6571optimizers should use optab @code{rintdf2}.
6572
6573The default hook returns true for all inputs.
6574@end deftypefn
6575
5ae4887d 6576@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
fab7adbf 6577This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6578
6579The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
20d892d1 6580available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6581as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6582That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6583that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6584either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6585(b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6586
5ae4887d 6587@var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that
6588do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.
fab7adbf 6589
6590In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6591@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6592instructions.
6593
6594On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6595for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
12057c3c 6596necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6597for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6598operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6599
24833e1a 6600When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6601false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
12057c3c 6602size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
fab7adbf 6603
6604The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6605processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6606@end deftypefn
6607
3754d046 6608@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
0682c48a 6609This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6610@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6611the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6612
6613For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6614true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6615instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6616all addresses will have equal costs.
6617
6618In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6619the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6620cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6621
6622For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6623and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6624is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6625references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6626the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6627that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6628instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6629specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6630
6631This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6632
6633On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6634cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6635@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6636be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6637@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6638should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6639should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6640registers on machines with lots of registers.
6641@end deftypefn
6642
1019399a 6643@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MAX_NOCE_IFCVT_SEQ_COST (edge @var{e})
6644This hook returns a value in the same units as @code{TARGET_RTX_COSTS},
6645giving the maximum acceptable cost for a sequence generated by the RTL
6646if-conversion pass when conditional execution is not available.
6647The RTL if-conversion pass attempts to convert conditional operations
6648that would require a branch to a series of unconditional operations and
6649@code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns. This hook returns the maximum cost of the
6650unconditional instructions and the @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns.
6651RTL if-conversion is cancelled if the cost of the converted sequence
6652is greater than the value returned by this hook.
6653
6654@code{e} is the edge between the basic block containing the conditional
6655branch to the basic block which would be executed if the condition
6656were true.
6657
6658The default implementation of this hook uses the
6659@code{max-rtl-if-conversion-[un]predictable} parameters if they are set,
6660and uses a multiple of @code{BRANCH_COST} otherwise.
6661@end deftypefn
6662
e000adb9 6663@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NOCE_CONVERSION_PROFITABLE_P (rtx_insn *@var{seq}, struct noce_if_info *@var{if_info})
6664This hook returns true if the instruction sequence @code{seq} is a good
6665candidate as a replacement for the if-convertible sequence described in
6666@code{if_info}.
6667@end deftypefn
6668
0f177fa9 6669@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_SPECULATION_IN_DELAY_SLOTS_P (void)
6670This predicate controls the use of the eager delay slot filler to disallow
6671speculatively executed instructions being placed in delay slots. Targets
6672such as certain MIPS architectures possess both branches with and without
6673delay slots. As the eager delay slot filler can decrease performance,
6674disabling it is beneficial when ordinary branches are available. Use of
6675delay slot branches filled using the basic filler is often still desirable
6676as the delay slot can hide a pipeline bubble.
6677@end deftypefn
6678
747af5e7 6679@node Scheduling
6680@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6681
6682The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6683adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6684hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6685them: try the first ones in this list first.
6686
6687@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
bea4bad2 6688This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6689issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6690Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6691an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6692constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6693hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6694This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6695it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
747af5e7 6696@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6697@end deftypefn
6698
18282db0 6699@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
747af5e7 6700This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6701from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
2d1a9add 6702still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6703@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6704@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6705You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6706than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6707@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6708debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6709@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6710was scheduled.
747af5e7 6711@end deftypefn
6712
99f52c2b 6713@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{dep_type1}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost}, unsigned int @var{dw})
bea4bad2 6714This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
99f52c2b 6715relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through a
6716dependence of type dep_type, and strength @var{dw}. It should return the new
6717value. The default is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be
6718used for example to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline
6719description that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost
6720as a data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
bea4bad2 6721description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6722output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6723times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6724acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
67900a4f 6725@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
747af5e7 6726@end deftypefn
6727
18282db0 6728@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
747af5e7 6729This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6a1cdb4d 6730@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6731execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
747af5e7 6732later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6733scheduling priorities of insns.
6734@end deftypefn
6735
b24ef467 6736@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
747af5e7 6737This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6738list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6739combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6740@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6741debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6742@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6743list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6744a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6745reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
24833e1a 6746@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
747af5e7 6747is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6748the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6749can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6750@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6751@end deftypefn
6752
b24ef467 6753@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
747af5e7 6754Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6755function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6756is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6757@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6758return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6759this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6760scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6761cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6762@end deftypefn
6763
641b578b 6764@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
6765This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
6766@end deftypefn
6767
524474b3 6768@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr})
6769This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for
6770a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
6771(@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched
6772group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either
6773two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should
6774validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.
641b578b 6775@end deftypefn
6776
b24ef467 6777@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
58ada791 6778This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6779chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6780correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6781example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6782analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6783dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6784calculated.
6785@end deftypefn
6786
747af5e7 6787@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6788This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6789instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6790pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6791is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6792@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6793region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
805d6554 6794scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
747af5e7 6795@end deftypefn
6796
6797@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6798This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6799instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6800cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6801is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6802to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6803@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6804@end deftypefn
6805
f77a5bb0 6806@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6807This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6808@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6809@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6810@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6811@end deftypefn
6812
6813@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
b3d47662 6814This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
f77a5bb0 6815@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6816@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6817@end deftypefn
6818
5f77f12a 6819@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
bea4bad2 6820The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6821pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6822when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6823simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6824processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6825based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6826when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6827@end deftypefn
6828
6829@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6830The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6831@end deftypefn
6832
18282db0 6833@deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
bea4bad2 6834The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6835to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6836simulated processor cycle finishes.
6837@end deftypefn
6838
6839@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6840The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6841used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6842@end deftypefn
6843
5f77f12a 6844@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
07317795 6845The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6846The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
83d10720 6847to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
07317795 6848state on a single insn is not enough.
6849@end deftypefn
6850
5f77f12a 6851@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
07317795 6852The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6853The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
83d10720 6854to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
07317795 6855state on a single insn is not enough.
6856@end deftypefn
6857
bea4bad2 6858@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6859This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6860for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6861chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6862value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6863@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6864subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6865maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6866@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6867packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6868rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6869
6870This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6871processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6872with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6873@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6874@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6875processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6876@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6877until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6878the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6879
6880Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6881pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6882schedules to choose the best one.
6883
6884The default is no multipass scheduling.
6885@end deftypefn
6886
18282db0 6887@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
58ada791 6888
6889This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6890considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
d9d89d92 6891zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
6892Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
6893the current round of multipass scheduling.
6894Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
6895number of cycles.
6896Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
6897instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed
6898to allow backends make correct judgements.
58ada791 6899
5dd077a2 6900The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
58ada791 6901@end deftypefn
6902
d9d89d92 6903@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
44ad1e56 6904This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6905scheduling.
6906@end deftypefn
6907
18282db0 6908@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
44ad1e56 6909This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6910@end deftypefn
6911
d9d89d92 6912@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
44ad1e56 6913This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6914an instruction.
6915@end deftypefn
6916
6917@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6918This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6919round of multipass scheduling.
6920@end deftypefn
6921
6922@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
b59688ee 6923This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
44ad1e56 6924@end deftypefn
6925
6926@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
b59688ee 6927This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
44ad1e56 6928@end deftypefn
6929
18282db0 6930@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
7c5f74ee 6931This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6932on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6933@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6934the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6935is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6936start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6937verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6938@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6939processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6940and the current processor cycle.
58ada791 6941@end deftypefn
6942
f2779bd1 6943@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
52c4b43f 6944This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
7a0ad664 6945the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
52c4b43f 6946are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
9997bd27 6947to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6948being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
f2779bd1 6949dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
7a0ad664 6950parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
52c4b43f 6951The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6952insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6953and @code{false} otherwise.
6954
6955Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
7a0ad664 6956where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
52c4b43f 6957delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
7a0ad664 6958that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
52c4b43f 6959important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
01e3cadf 6960closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
f2779bd1 6961not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
52c4b43f 6962@end deftypefn
6963
6a1cdb4d 6964@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6965This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6966the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6967per instruction data structures.
6968@end deftypefn
6969
ddc6a57f 6970@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
e1ab7874 6971Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6972@end deftypefn
6973
6974@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6975Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6976It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
35c16056 6977beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
e1ab7874 6978@end deftypefn
6979
6980@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
5f77f12a 6981Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
e1ab7874 6982@end deftypefn
6983
6984@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6985Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6986@end deftypefn
6987
6988@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6989Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6990@end deftypefn
6991
18282db0 6992@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6db57367 6993This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6994speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6995The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6996version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6997pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
1cbc9316 6998or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6a1cdb4d 6999speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
7000the generated speculative pattern.
7001@end deftypefn
7002
242d1ee6 7003@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
6a1cdb4d 7004This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
f2779bd1 7005for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
7006instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6a1cdb4d 7007@end deftypefn
7008
18282db0 7009@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
6a1cdb4d 7010This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6db57367 7011check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
7012speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
7013@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
7014be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
7015recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
7016a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6a1cdb4d 7017@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
7018@end deftypefn
7019
20beac72 7020@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6db57367 7021This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
20beac72 7022enabled/used.
7023The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6a1cdb4d 7024The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
7025@end deftypefn
7026
87417bbc 7027@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_CAN_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
7028Some instructions should never be speculated by the schedulers, usually
7029 because the instruction is too expensive to get this wrong. Often such
7030 instructions have long latency, and often they are not fully modeled in the
7031 pipeline descriptions. This hook should return @code{false} if @var{insn}
7032 should not be speculated.
7033@end deftypefn
7034
d52fd16a 7035@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
7036This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
7037resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
7038the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
7039backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
7040bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
7041of instructions divided by the issue rate.
7042@end deftypefn
7043
18282db0 7044@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
0ac9454e 7045This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
7046is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
7047@end deftypefn
7048
18282db0 7049@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
0ac9454e 7050This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
7051in its second parameter.
7052@end deftypefn
7053
6c2d9e41 7054@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
7055True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
7056the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
7057also the latencies of operations.
7058@end deftypevr
7059
3754d046 7060@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode})
5b1c765d 7061This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
7062parallelism required in output calculations chain.
7063@end deftypefn
7064
012ad66c 7065@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri})
7066This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion
7067priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities
7068are returned via pointer parameters.
7069
7070@var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.
7071@var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.
7072@var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s
7073fusion priority should be calculated and returned.
7074@var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority
7075should be calculated and returned.
7076
7077Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should
7078be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for
7079instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major
7080sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be
7081scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated
7082should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid
7083false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be
7084scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant
7085instructions.
7086
7087Given below example:
7088
665c43da 7089@smallexample
012ad66c 7090 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7091 add r4, r4, r10
7092 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7093 sub r5, r5, r15
7094 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7095 add r4, r4, r11
7096 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7097 sub r5, r5, r16
665c43da 7098@end smallexample
012ad66c 7099
7100On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be
7101merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive
7102loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where
7103this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each
7104instruction based on its fustion type, like:
7105
665c43da 7106@smallexample
7107 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96
7108 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7109 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92
7110 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7111 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100
7112 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7113 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88
7114 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7115@end smallexample
012ad66c 7116
7117Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according
7118to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be
7119pushed together in instruction flow, like:
7120
665c43da 7121@smallexample
012ad66c 7122 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7123 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7124 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7125 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7126 add r4, r4, r10
7127 sub r5, r5, r15
7128 add r4, r4, r11
7129 sub r5, r5, r16
665c43da 7130@end smallexample
012ad66c 7131
7132Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.
7133
7134Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion
7135work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.
7136
7137This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to
7138the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.
7139@end deftypefn
7140
67f7b566 7141@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_DIVMOD_LIBFUNC (rtx @var{libfunc}, machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{op0}, rtx @var{op1}, rtx *@var{quot}, rtx *@var{rem})
7142Define this hook for enabling divmod transform if the port does not have
7143hardware divmod insn but defines target-specific divmod libfuncs.
7144@end deftypefn
7145
889fd92b 7146@node Sections
7147@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
7148@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
7149@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
7150
7151An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
7152data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
7153section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
7154section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
7155section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
7156of sections.
7157
2f14b1f9 7158@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
7159@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
7160The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
7161is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
7162as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
7163initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
7164They may however depend on command-line flags.
7165
7166@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
7167use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
7168to be string literals.
7169
7170Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
7171section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
7172should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
7173@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
7174
7175You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
7176@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
7177in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
7178@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
7179create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
7180reuse @code{text_section}.
7181
7182All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
7183if the target does not provide them.
889fd92b 7184
d37d6c0b 7185@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
b01e21ca 7186A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7187assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
7188Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
d37d6c0b 7189@end defmac
033e4d6d 7190
d37d6c0b 7191@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
429fa7fa 7192If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
7193frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
7194a default definition if the target supports named sections.
d37d6c0b 7195@end defmac
429fa7fa 7196
d37d6c0b 7197@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
429fa7fa 7198If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
7199executed functions in the program.
d37d6c0b 7200@end defmac
429fa7fa 7201
d37d6c0b 7202@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
b01e21ca 7203A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7204assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
7205data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
d37d6c0b 7206@end defmac
889fd92b 7207
2f14b1f9 7208@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7209If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7210containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7211initialized, writable small data.
7212@end defmac
7213
d37d6c0b 7214@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6cde52a2 7215A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7216assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
7217data.
d37d6c0b 7218@end defmac
6cde52a2 7219
d37d6c0b 7220@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
b01e21ca 7221If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7222containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
707b84a3 7223uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
fa8d6f0f 7224@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
b01e21ca 7225uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
8ae77b3c 7226@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
b01e21ca 7227used.
d37d6c0b 7228@end defmac
889fd92b 7229
2f14b1f9 7230@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7231If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7232containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7233uninitialized, writable small data.
7234@end defmac
7235
7d167d36 7236@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
7237If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
7238assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
7239common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
7240@end defmac
7241
7242@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7243If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7244containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
7245default is @code{'T'}.
7246@end defmac
7247
d37d6c0b 7248@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
b01e21ca 7249If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7250containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7251initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5dd7e24d 7252not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
7253variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
d37d6c0b 7254@end defmac
889fd92b 7255
d37d6c0b 7256@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
b01e21ca 7257If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7258containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7259finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
5dd7e24d 7260not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
7261variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
d37d6c0b 7262@end defmac
4f18499c 7263
d24bc145 7264@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7265If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7266containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7267part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7268defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7269both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7270@end defmac
b215c058 7271
d24bc145 7272@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7273If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7274containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7275part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7276defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7277both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7278@end defmac
7279
97920c79 7280@defmac MACH_DEP_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7281If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7282containing the flag used to mark a machine-dependent section. This
7283corresponds to the @code{SECTION_MACH_DEP} section flag.
7284@end defmac
7285
d37d6c0b 7286@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
e1ff7102 7287If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7288via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7289the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7290@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7291to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7292sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
b2fb871e 7293ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7294registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7295constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
d37d6c0b 7296@end defmac
b2fb871e 7297
91e8ab5c 7298@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7299If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7300variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7301when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7302you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7303they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7304expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7305MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7306require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7307to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7308access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
f7df448c 7309@end defmac
91e8ab5c 7310
d37d6c0b 7311@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
e1ff7102 7312If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7313arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7314@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7315and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
d37d6c0b 7316@end defmac
e1ff7102 7317
d37d6c0b 7318@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
f45856ef 7319Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6b5be7f8 7320tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7321section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7322readonly data section is used.
889fd92b 7323
7324This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
d37d6c0b 7325@end defmac
889fd92b 7326
2f14b1f9 7327@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7328Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7329@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7330of its own that you need to create.
7331
7332GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7333any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7334described below.
7335@end deftypefn
7336
5f77f12a 7337@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
4e151b05 7338Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7339selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7340should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7341local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7342
7343The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7344is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7345when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7346in read-only sections even in executables.
7347@end deftypefn
7348
2f14b1f9 7349@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7350Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
52470889 7351assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7352some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7353requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7354local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
2f14b1f9 7355@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
52470889 7356
7357The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7358variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
bd25c0c1 7359
7360See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
52470889 7361@end deftypefn
7362
bd25c0c1 7363@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7364Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7365for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7366
7367In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7368function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7369it is unlikely to be called.
7370@end defmac
7371
52470889 7372@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7373Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7374and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7375As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7376the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7377
7378The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7379ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7380example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7381Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7382@end deftypefn
7383
2f14b1f9 7384@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7385Return the readonly data section associated with
76aec42f 7386@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
2f14b1f9 7387The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7388the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7389if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7390otherwise.
76aec42f 7391@end deftypefn
7392
6e71bd21 7393@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7394Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7395section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7396the string if a different section name should be used.
7397@end deftypevr
7398
e3ef604c 7399@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7400Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7401@end deftypefn
7402
3754d046 7403@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
2f14b1f9 7404Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7405should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
bbfbe351 7406constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
2f14b1f9 7407case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7408in bits.
bbfbe351 7409
7410The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7411constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7412else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7413@end deftypefn
7414
5f77f12a 7415@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
97a424bc 7416Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7417by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7418the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7419or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7420hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7421your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7422returns the @var{id} provided.
7423@end deftypefn
7424
2c129d70 7425@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7811991d 7426Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7427treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7428function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7429
2c129d70 7430The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7431@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7432an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7433rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
b56337d2 7434in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
2c129d70 7435
7436In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7437a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7438will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7439register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7440rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7441leave it alone.)
7811991d 7442
7443The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
2c129d70 7444that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7811991d 7445be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7446declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7447declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
2c129d70 7448@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7811991d 7449
7450@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
2c129d70 7451The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7452@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7453Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7454encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7455discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7456
7457The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7458in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7459@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7460before overriding it.
7811991d 7461@end deftypefn
7462
5f77f12a 7463@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7b4a38a6 7464Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7465the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7466may have added.
7467@end deftypefn
7468
ddc6a57f 7469@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
33459320 7470Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7471The default version of this hook always returns false.
7472@end deftypefn
7473
48a84cee 7474@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
4ddb893b 7475Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7476``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
48a84cee 7477@end deftypevr
4ddb893b 7478
8637d6a2 7479@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7480It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7481
7482The default version of this hook use the target macro
7483@code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7484@end deftypefn
7485
ddc6a57f 7486@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
33459320 7487Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7488rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7489or executable image).
7490
7491The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7492for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7493currently supported object file formats.
7494@end deftypefn
7495
48a84cee 7496@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
4ddb893b 7497Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7498The default value is false.
48a84cee 7499@end deftypevr
4ddb893b 7500
7501
889fd92b 7502@node PIC
7503@section Position Independent Code
7504@cindex position independent code
7505@cindex PIC
7506
7507This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7508independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
fd50b071 7509generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7510@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7511@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7512must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7513when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7514need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7515relative addresses.
15b474a2 7516@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
889fd92b 7517@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7518
d37d6c0b 7519@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
889fd92b 7520The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7521data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
0858e3a2 7522processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
889fd92b 7523is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7524pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7525is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
9d2337eb 7526necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
41828ba0 7527when @code{flag_pic} is true).
d37d6c0b 7528@end defmac
889fd92b 7529
d37d6c0b 7530@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
260e669e 7531A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7532@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7533the default is zero. Do not define
c2aec324 7534this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
d37d6c0b 7535@end defmac
889fd92b 7536
d37d6c0b 7537@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
889fd92b 7538A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7539operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7540You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7541check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7542check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7543(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7544position independent code.
d37d6c0b 7545@end defmac
889fd92b 7546
7547@node Assembler Format
7548@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7549
7550This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7fe22e19 7551to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
889fd92b 7552instructions do.
7553
7554@menu
7555* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7556* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7557* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7558* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7559* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
c24c5fac 7560 and termination routines.
889fd92b 7561* Macros for Initialization::
c24c5fac 7562 Specific macros that control the handling of
7563 initialization and termination routines.
889fd92b 7564* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7565* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7566* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7567* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7568@end menu
7569
7570@node File Framework
7571@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7572@cindex assembler format
7573@cindex output of assembler code
7574
7575@c prevent bad page break with this line
92c473b8 7576This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7577
92c473b8 7578@findex default_file_start
5f77f12a 7579@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
92c473b8 7580Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7581find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7582by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7583quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7584@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7585lets other target files rely on these variables.
7586@end deftypefn
889fd92b 7587
92c473b8 7588@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7589If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7590printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7591@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7592to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7593definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7594assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7595whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7596
7597The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7598verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7599comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7600@end deftypevr
7601
7602@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7603If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7604for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7605@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7606this to be done. The default is false.
7607@end deftypevr
889fd92b 7608
ddc6a57f 7609@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
f6940372 7610Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7611to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7612@end deftypefn
889fd92b 7613
f6940372 7614@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7615Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7616special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7617the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7618should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7619need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7620this function.
7621@end deftypefun
889fd92b 7622
23433d72 7623@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7624Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7625to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7626nothing.
7627@end deftypefn
7628
7629@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7630Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7631to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7632nothing.
7633@end deftypefn
7634
5cbd74a3 7635@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7636Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7637unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7638here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7639because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7640nothing.
7641@end deftypefn
7642
d37d6c0b 7643@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
889fd92b 7644A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7645assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7646the end of the line.
d37d6c0b 7647@end defmac
889fd92b 7648
d37d6c0b 7649@defmac ASM_APP_ON
889fd92b 7650A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7651statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7652@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7653assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7654that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
d37d6c0b 7655@end defmac
889fd92b 7656
d37d6c0b 7657@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
889fd92b 7658A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7659statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7660@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7661time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
d37d6c0b 7662@end defmac
889fd92b 7663
d37d6c0b 7664@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
889fd92b 7665A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7666which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7667the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7668
7669This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7670for the file format in use is appropriate.
d37d6c0b 7671@end defmac
889fd92b 7672
e2823fde 7673@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7674Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7afe6404 7675
e2823fde 7676 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7677@end deftypefn
7678
367b1459 7679@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7680Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7681@end deftypefn
7682
d37d6c0b 7683@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
0dbd1c74 7684A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7685@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
e8e57187 7686in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
0dbd1c74 7687the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7688of the filename using this macro.
d37d6c0b 7689@end defmac
0dbd1c74 7690
5f77f12a 7691@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
2cb4ac60 7692Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7693should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
5f77f12a 7694of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7695is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7696this section is associated.
2cb4ac60 7697@end deftypefn
7698
9753b549 7699@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_ELF_FLAGS_NUMERIC (unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int *@var{num})
7700This hook can be used to encode ELF section flags for which no letter
7701code has been defined in the assembler. It is called by
7702@code{default_asm_named_section} whenever the section flags need to be
7703emitted in the assembler output. If the hook returns true, then the
7704numerical value for ELF section flags should be calculated from
01977fbd 7705@var{flags} and saved in @var{*num}; the value is printed out instead of the
7706normal sequence of letter codes. If the hook is not defined, or if it
7707returns false, then @var{num} is ignored and the traditional letter sequence
7708is emitted.
9753b549 7709@end deftypefn
7710
3b73548b 7711@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7712Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7713Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
15b474a2 7714functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
3b73548b 7715at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7716@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7717(from static destructors).
7718Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7719@end deftypefn
7720
3b3edcd4 7721@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7722Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7723@end deftypefn
7724
218e3e4e 7725@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
2cb4ac60 7726This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
b213bf24 7727It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
5f77f12a 7728@end deftypevr
2cb4ac60 7729
102e3995 7730@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
5f77f12a 7731@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
102e3995 7732This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7733section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7734This is true on most ELF targets.
5f77f12a 7735@end deftypevr
102e3995 7736
2cb4ac60 7737@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7738Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7739based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7740declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
c24c5fac 7741null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
2cb4ac60 7742
d2024693 7743The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
2cb4ac60 7744read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7745need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7746set via @code{__attribute__}.
7747@end deftypefn
7748
ddc6a57f 7749@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7c6733e8 7750Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7751switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7752enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7753It can take the following values:
7754
7755@table @gcctabopt
7756@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7757@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7758
7759@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7760@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7761direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7762default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7763command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7764various different individual optimization passes.
7765
7766@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7767@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7768ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7769target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7770time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7771warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7772wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7773necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7774perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7775switches.
7776
7777@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7778This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7779
7780@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7781This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7782@end table
7783
7784The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7785supported in the future.
7786
7787By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7788provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7789it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7790section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7791provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7792hook.
7793@end deftypefn
7794
5f77f12a 7795@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7c6733e8 7796This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7797ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7798hook.
5f77f12a 7799@end deftypevr
7c6733e8 7800
889fd92b 7801@need 2000
7802@node Data Output
7803@subsection Output of Data
7804
58356836 7805
7806@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7807@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7808@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7809@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7810@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7811@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7812@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7813@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7814@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7815These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7816of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7817byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7818aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7819@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7820
7821The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7822followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7823the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7824@end deftypevr
7825
7826@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7827The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7828integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7829in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7830function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7831object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7832split the object into smaller parts.
7833
7834The default implementation of this hook will use the
7835@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7836when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7837@end deftypefn
889fd92b 7838
d895e9da 7839@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void)
7840Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to
7841terminate an initialized variable declaration.
7842@end deftypefn
7843
1282f299 7844@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7845A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7846can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7847the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7848@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7849
7850If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7851so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7852itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7853return @code{true}.
7854@end deftypefn
7855
d37d6c0b 7856@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
889fd92b 7857A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7858instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7859bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7860@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7861
7862If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7863Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7864@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
d37d6c0b 7865@end defmac
889fd92b 7866
d37d6c0b 7867@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
6bfa2cc1 7868A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7869@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7870is defined, and is otherwise unused.
d37d6c0b 7871@end defmac
6bfa2cc1 7872
d37d6c0b 7873@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
071cd279 7874You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
f45856ef 7875expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
071cd279 7876pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
e8e57187 7877GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7878not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
071cd279 7879pool before the function.
d37d6c0b 7880@end defmac
071cd279 7881
d37d6c0b 7882@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
889fd92b 7883A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7884constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7885the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7886be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7887is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7888immediately after this call.
7889
7890If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7891not be defined.
d37d6c0b 7892@end defmac
889fd92b 7893
d37d6c0b 7894@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
889fd92b 7895A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7896constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7897anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7898
7899The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7900assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7901output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7902@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7903@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7904alignment.
7905
7906The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7907the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7908responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7909Here is how to do this:
7910
a0ecd6b1 7911@smallexample
805e22b2 7912@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
a0ecd6b1 7913@end smallexample
889fd92b 7914
7915When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7916@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7917entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7918
7919You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
d37d6c0b 7920@end defmac
889fd92b 7921
d37d6c0b 7922@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
071cd279 7923A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7924pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7925function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7926obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
e8e57187 7927constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
071cd279 7928
7929If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7930define this macro.
d37d6c0b 7931@end defmac
071cd279 7932
0cb73417 7933@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
889fd92b 7934Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
0cb73417 7935used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7936to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7937a line separator uses multiple characters.
889fd92b 7938
7939If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7940the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
d37d6c0b 7941@end defmac
889fd92b 7942
9ee9a4dc 7943@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
9d683ac8 7944@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
11ff5d0d 7945These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7946assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7947default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
9ee9a4dc 7948@end deftypevr
11ff5d0d 7949
c24c5fac 7950These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
889fd92b 7951of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7952
d37d6c0b 7953@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7954@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7955@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
66ac479a 7956@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7957@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7958@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7959These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7960target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7961the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7962@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7963simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7964@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7965by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7966it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
796732 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7968on the host machine.
889fd92b 7969
7970The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7971using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7972machine's memory.
d37d6c0b 7973@end defmac
889fd92b 7974
7975@node Uninitialized Data
7976@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7977
7978Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7979outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7980
d37d6c0b 7981@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
889fd92b 7982A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7983@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7984@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7b897de3 7985is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7986possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7987other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7988backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7989byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7990equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7991the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7992an ordinary undefined external.
889fd92b 7993
7994Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7995output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7996assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7997
7998This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7999common global variables are output.
d37d6c0b 8000@end defmac
889fd92b 8001
d37d6c0b 8002@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
889fd92b 8003Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
8004separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
8005place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
8006handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
8007as the number of bits.
d37d6c0b 8008@end defmac
889fd92b 8009
d37d6c0b 8010@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
0dbd1c74 8011Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
8012variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
3387c533 8013is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
0dbd1c74 8014in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
8015@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
8016the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
d37d6c0b 8017@end defmac
0dbd1c74 8018
fa8d6f0f 8019@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
889fd92b 8020A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8021@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
fa8d6f0f 8022@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
8023is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
889fd92b 8024
fa8d6f0f 8025Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
8026@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
889fd92b 8027@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
8028before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
8029the name, and a newline.
8030
fa8d6f0f 8031There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
102e3995 8032The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
8033switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
8034You do not need to do both.
8035
8036Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
8037non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
8038efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
8039not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
8040common in order to save space in the object file.
d37d6c0b 8041@end defmac
889fd92b 8042
d37d6c0b 8043@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
889fd92b 8044A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8045@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
8046@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
8047is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
8048
8049Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8050output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8051assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
8052
8053This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
8054static variables are output.
d37d6c0b 8055@end defmac
889fd92b 8056
d37d6c0b 8057@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
889fd92b 8058Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
8059separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
8060place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
8061handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
8062as the number of bits.
d37d6c0b 8063@end defmac
889fd92b 8064
d37d6c0b 8065@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
0dbd1c74 8066Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
8067variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
3387c533 8068is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
0dbd1c74 8069in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
8070@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
8071the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
d37d6c0b 8072@end defmac
0dbd1c74 8073
889fd92b 8074@node Label Output
8075@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
8076
8077@c prevent bad page break with this line
8078This is about outputting labels.
8079
889fd92b 8080@findex assemble_name
d37d6c0b 8081@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
889fd92b 8082A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8083@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
8084Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8085output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
9bf98a09 8086assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8087definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
d37d6c0b 8088@end defmac
889fd92b 8089
2761b7cb 8090@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8091A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8092@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
8093a function.
8094Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8095output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8096assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8097definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8098
8099If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8100usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8101@end defmac
8102
48126f0c 8103@findex assemble_name_raw
8104@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
ebe7d53d 8105Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
48126f0c 8106to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
8107@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
8108that it is more efficient.
8109@end defmac
8110
d37d6c0b 8111@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
ef7af4c3 8112A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8113size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8114default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
8115systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8116
8117Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
8118of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
8119for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
8120macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
8121define this macro.
d37d6c0b 8122@end defmac
ef7af4c3 8123
d37d6c0b 8124@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
ef7af4c3 8125A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8126@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
8127symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8128If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8129provided.
d37d6c0b 8130@end defmac
ef7af4c3 8131
d37d6c0b 8132@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
ef7af4c3 8133A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8134@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
a7424888 8135the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
894b8fd9 8136address.
a7424888 8137
8138If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8139provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
8140@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
8141the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
8142not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
8143to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
d37d6c0b 8144@end defmac
ef7af4c3 8145
75a15fa3 8146@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8147Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8148@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
8149G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
8150@samp{.} is used instead.
8151@end defmac
8152
8153@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8154Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8155@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
8156have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
8157are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
8158@end defmac
8159
d37d6c0b 8160@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
ef7af4c3 8161A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8162type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8163default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
8164systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8165
8166Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8167@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8168custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8169types at all, do not define this macro.
d37d6c0b 8170@end defmac
ef7af4c3 8171
d37d6c0b 8172@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
ef7af4c3 8173A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
8174the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
8175default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
8176the default is not to define this macro.
8177
8178Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8179@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8180custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8181types at all, do not define this macro.
d37d6c0b 8182@end defmac
ef7af4c3 8183
d37d6c0b 8184@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
ef7af4c3 8185A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8186@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
8187symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
8188that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
8189you should not count on this.
8190
8191If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
8192definition of this macro is provided.
d37d6c0b 8193@end defmac
ef7af4c3 8194
d37d6c0b 8195@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
889fd92b 8196A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8197@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8198function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
8199outputting the label definition (perhaps using
2761b7cb 8200@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
889fd92b 8201@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8202
8203If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
2761b7cb 8204usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
889fd92b 8205
ef7af4c3 8206You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8207of this macro.
d37d6c0b 8208@end defmac
ef7af4c3 8209
d37d6c0b 8210@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
889fd92b 8211A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8212@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
8213which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8214function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
8215representing the function.
8216
8217If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
8218
ef7af4c3 8219You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8220of this macro.
d37d6c0b 8221@end defmac
ef7af4c3 8222
a59970a6 8223@defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8224A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8225@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8226cold function partition which is being defined. This macro is responsible
8227for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8228@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8229@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8230
8231If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the
8232usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8233
8234You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8235of this macro.
8236@end defmac
8237
8238@defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8239A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8240@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function
8241partition which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8242cold partition of the function. The argument @var{decl} is the
8243@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8244
8245If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined.
8246
8247You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8248of this macro.
8249@end defmac
8250
d37d6c0b 8251@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
889fd92b 8252A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8253@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
8254initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
8255label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
8256@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
8257
8258If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
8259usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8260
ef7af4c3 8261You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8262@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
d37d6c0b 8263@end defmac
ef7af4c3 8264
8c38d114 8265@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
427eb138 8266A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
8267for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
8268target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8269@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
8270and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
8271will be an internal label.
7edf3a2b 8272
427eb138 8273The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
8274usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7edf3a2b 8275
427eb138 8276You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
8277@end deftypefn
7edf3a2b 8278
d37d6c0b 8279@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
d300bd48 8280A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8281@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
8282for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
8283
8284If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8285nothing.
d37d6c0b 8286@end defmac
d300bd48 8287
d37d6c0b 8288@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
889fd92b 8289A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
8290once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
8291chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
8292initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
8293something about the size of the object.
8294
8295If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8296nothing.
8297
ef7af4c3 8298You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8299@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
d37d6c0b 8300@end defmac
ef7af4c3 8301
67c1e638 8302@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
8303This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
889fd92b 8304@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
67c1e638 8305that is, available for reference from other files.
889fd92b 8306
67c1e638 8307The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
8308@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
95304098 8309@end deftypefn
33b14b1e 8310
9afff52d 8311@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
8312This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8313@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
8314global; that is, available for reference from other files.
8315
8316The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
8317@end deftypefn
8318
7260826d 8319@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl})
8320This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8321@var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with
8322@var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most
8323assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.
8324@end deftypefn
8325
d37d6c0b 8326@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
889fd92b 8327A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8328@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
8329that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
8330no other definition is available. Use the expression
8331@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
8332itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8333for making that name weak, and a newline.
8334
ee0125fb 8335If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8336support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8337macro.
d37d6c0b 8338@end defmac
ee0125fb 8339
d37d6c0b 8340@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
ee0125fb 8341Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8342@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8343or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8344should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8345defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8346@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8347to make @var{name} weak.
d37d6c0b 8348@end defmac
889fd92b 8349
b0988db1 8350@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8351Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8352symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8353declaration of @code{name}.
8354@end defmac
8355
d37d6c0b 8356@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
293c8430 8357A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8358supports weak symbols.
889fd92b 8359
8360If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
ee0125fb 8361definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
293c8430 8362is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8363@end defmac
8364
8365@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8366A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8367
8368If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8369definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8370this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8371flag such as @option{-melf}.
d37d6c0b 8372@end defmac
889fd92b 8373
d37d6c0b 8374@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
889fd92b 8375A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8376public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8377be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8378format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8379section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8380requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
d37d6c0b 8381@end defmac
889fd92b 8382
d37d6c0b 8383@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
889fd92b 8384A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8385semantics.
8386
8387If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8388definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8389definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
0dbd1c74 8390you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
889fd92b 8391setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8392be emitted as one-only.
d37d6c0b 8393@end defmac
889fd92b 8394
5f77f12a 8395@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
2532673e 8396This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8397commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8398hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8399@end deftypefn
8400
9bb1c6fd 8401@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
2f9fc8ef 8402A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
9bb1c6fd 8403that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
9e7454d0 8404The default is @code{0}.
9bb1c6fd 8405
8406Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8407if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8408will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8409symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8410thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8411(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8412with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8413
8414The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8415targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8416restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8417table of contents.
2f9fc8ef 8418@end defmac
8419
d37d6c0b 8420@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
889fd92b 8421A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8422@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8423symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8424not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8425declaration.
8426
8427This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8428The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
d37d6c0b 8429@end defmac
889fd92b 8430
864af209 8431@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8432This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
889fd92b 8433pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
864af209 8434library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8435@end deftypefn
889fd92b 8436
5f77f12a 8437@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
9423c9b7 8438This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
5f77f12a 8439directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8440.no_dead_code_strip directive.
9423c9b7 8441@end deftypefn
8442
d37d6c0b 8443@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
889fd92b 8444A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8445@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8446@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8447is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8448systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
d37d6c0b 8449@end defmac
889fd92b 8450
d86d364d 8451@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8452Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8453@end deftypefn
8454
d37d6c0b 8455@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
258e5000 8456A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
633beede 8457@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
258e5000 8458will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8459to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
7811991d 8460encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
d37d6c0b 8461@end defmac
258e5000 8462
d37d6c0b 8463@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
633beede 8464A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
a22d2169 8465result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
633beede 8466@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8467This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8468specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
a22d2169 8469when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8470being taken.
d37d6c0b 8471@end defmac
633beede 8472
805e22b2 8473@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8474A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8475name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
889fd92b 8476
8477It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8478used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8479will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8480
8481It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8482object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8483should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8484beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8485convention your system uses, and follow it.
8486
b3d47662 8487The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
805e22b2 8488@end deftypefn
889fd92b 8489
d37d6c0b 8490@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
64e17633 8491A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8492label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8493@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8494may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8495systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8496bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8497bundles.
8498
805e22b2 8499If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
64e17633 8500used.
d37d6c0b 8501@end defmac
64e17633 8502
d37d6c0b 8503@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
889fd92b 8504A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8505is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8506
8507This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
805e22b2 8508produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
889fd92b 8509with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8510
8511If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8512output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8513@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8514string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8515to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8516@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8517you should know what it does on your machine.)
d37d6c0b 8518@end defmac
889fd92b 8519
d37d6c0b 8520@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
889fd92b 8521A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8522@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8523@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8524added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8525
8526The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8527produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8528@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8529assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8530macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8531internal static variables in different scopes.
8532
8533Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8534conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8535or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8536between the name and the number will suffice.
8537
805e22b2 8538If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8539which is correct for most systems.
d37d6c0b 8540@end defmac
805e22b2 8541
d37d6c0b 8542@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
889fd92b 8543A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8544which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8545
47d41401 8546@findex SET_ASM_OP
70c2c81c 8547If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
889fd92b 8548correct for most systems.
d37d6c0b 8549@end defmac
8ae28d4d 8550
d37d6c0b 8551@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
17827ae8 8552A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
ae7d2789 8553which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
17827ae8 8554to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8555be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8556the tree nodes are available.
8557
47d41401 8558@findex SET_ASM_OP
70c2c81c 8559If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
ad87de1e 8560correct for most systems.
d37d6c0b 8561@end defmac
ad87de1e 8562
137900fa 8563@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8564A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8565(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8566of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8567current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8568This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8569@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8570@end defmac
8571
d37d6c0b 8572@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8ae28d4d 8573A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8574which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
3285e530 8575@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8576an undefined weak symbol.
8ae28d4d 8577
8578Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
70c2c81c 8579@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
d37d6c0b 8580@end defmac
8ae28d4d 8581
d37d6c0b 8582@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
889fd92b 8583Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
3db5236b 8584Objective-C methods.
889fd92b 8585
8586The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8587class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8588the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8589@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8590
8591These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8592the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8593systems define other ways of computing names.
8594
8595@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8596buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8597@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
859850 characters extra.
8599
8600The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8601method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
dd5beb9d 8602@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
889fd92b 8603in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8604
8605On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8606macro to provide more human-readable names.
d37d6c0b 8607@end defmac
46a0fe07 8608
889fd92b 8609@node Initialization
8610@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8611@cindex initialization routines
8612@cindex termination routines
8613@cindex constructors, output of
8614@cindex destructors, output of
8615
8616The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8617(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8618data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8619to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8620@code{main} is called.
8621
8622Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8623@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8624terminates.
8625
8626To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8627must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8628be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8629system, you need to specify how to do this.
8630
8631There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8632initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8633Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8634
8635@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8636@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8637The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8638initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8639termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8640
8641Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
86420, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8643the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8644pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8645pointer containing zero.
8646
8647Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8648@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8649time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8650list; destructors in forward order.
8651
8652The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8653formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8654aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8655Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8656object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8657the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8658accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8659Termination functions are handled similarly.
8660
01d15dc5 8661This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8662@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
228c5b30 8663support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
01d15dc5 8664constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8665and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
889fd92b 8666
8667When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8668upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
01d15dc5 8669support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
889fd92b 8670parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
228c76d8 8671program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
889fd92b 8672
a0ecd6b1 8673@smallexample
01d15dc5 8674ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
a0ecd6b1 8675@end smallexample
889fd92b 8676
01d15dc5 8677The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8678section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8679for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8680files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8681are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8682
8683The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8684compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8685fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8686to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8687of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8688that invokes the routines we need at startup.
889fd92b 8689
8690To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8691macro properly.
8692
01d15dc5 8693If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8694@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8695entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8696it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8697after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8698in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
889fd92b 8699
8700In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8701two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8702and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
01d15dc5 8703@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
889fd92b 8704entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8705and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8706code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
01d15dc5 8707the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
889fd92b 8708placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8709a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
01d15dc5 8710@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
889fd92b 8711section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8712the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8713the initialization process.
8714
8715The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8716This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
0858e3a2 8717file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
01d15dc5 8718this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8719termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8720an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8721pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8722the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8723initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8724via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8725@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
889fd92b 8726
8727@ifinfo
8728The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8729customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8730@end ifinfo
8731
8732@node Macros for Initialization
8733@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8734
8735Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8736and termination functions:
8737
d37d6c0b 8738@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
b01e21ca 8739If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8740operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8741defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8742using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8743macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8744run the initialization functions.
d37d6c0b 8745@end defmac
889fd92b 8746
d37d6c0b 8747@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
889fd92b 8748If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
01d15dc5 8749This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8750on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8751be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
d37d6c0b 8752@end defmac
889fd92b 8753
d37d6c0b 8754@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
889fd92b 8755If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8756the following symbol is an initialization routine.
d37d6c0b 8757@end defmac
889fd92b 8758
d37d6c0b 8759@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
889fd92b 8760If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8761the following symbol is a finalization routine.
d37d6c0b 8762@end defmac
889fd92b 8763
d37d6c0b 8764@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
2f9e77d1 8765If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8766automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8767should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8768the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
27b200ed 8769function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
2f9e77d1 8770
8771This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
228c5b30 8772shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
2f9e77d1 8773exception tables embedded in the code.
d37d6c0b 8774@end defmac
2f9e77d1 8775
d37d6c0b 8776@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
2f9e77d1 8777If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8778automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8779should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8780the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
27b200ed 8781function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
d37d6c0b 8782@end defmac
2f9e77d1 8783
d37d6c0b 8784@defmac INVOKE__main
889fd92b 8785If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8786@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8787where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8788useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
d37d6c0b 8789@end defmac
889fd92b 8790
d37d6c0b 8791@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
246dd815 8792If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8793compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8794of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8795encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
d37d6c0b 8796@end defmac
01d15dc5 8797
5f77f12a 8798@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
01d15dc5 8799This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8800collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8801It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
5f77f12a 8802@end deftypevr
01d15dc5 8803
8804@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8805If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8806the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
246dd815 8807
01d15dc5 8808Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8809no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8810priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8811otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8812
7120b8b4 8813If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
01d15dc5 8814be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8815target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8816is not defined.
8817@end deftypefn
8818
8819@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8820This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
889fd92b 8821functions rather than initialization functions.
01d15dc5 8822@end deftypefn
624bbb1b 8823
01d15dc5 8824If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8825generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
889fd92b 8826
01d15dc5 8827If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8828constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8829an object file for constructor functions to be called.
624bbb1b 8830
4bfa9136 8831On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
01d15dc5 8832@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
889fd92b 8833
d37d6c0b 8834@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
889fd92b 8835Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
01d15dc5 8836object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
889fd92b 8837object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
889fd92b 8838
4bfa9136 8839This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
01d15dc5 8840part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
d37d6c0b 8841@end defmac
889fd92b 8842
d37d6c0b 8843@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
889fd92b 8844Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
01d15dc5 8845to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8846@command{nm}.
f369130e 8847@end defmac
8848
8849@defmac NM_FLAGS
8850@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8851constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8852passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
b59688ee 8853are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
f369130e 8854produces.
8855@end defmac
889fd92b 8856
8857If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8858dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8859these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8860termination functions in shared libraries:
8861
d37d6c0b 8862@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
01d15dc5 8863Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
f369130e 8864which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
d37d6c0b 8865@end defmac
889fd92b 8866
d37d6c0b 8867@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
889fd92b 8868Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
70c2c81c 8869of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
889fd92b 8870of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8871from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
70c2c81c 8872code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8873line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
d37d6c0b 8874@end defmac
889fd92b 8875
1ba3a590 8876@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8877Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8878library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8879strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8880constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8881that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8882@end defmac
8883
889fd92b 8884@node Instruction Output
8885@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8886
8887@c prevent bad page break with this line
8888This describes assembler instruction output.
8889
d37d6c0b 8890@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
889fd92b 8891A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8892registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8893register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
d37d6c0b 8894@end defmac
889fd92b 8895
d37d6c0b 8896@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
889fd92b 8897If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8898and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8899registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8900to registers using alternate names.
d37d6c0b 8901@end defmac
889fd92b 8902
ea26afd4 8903@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8904If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8905name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8906machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8907names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8908declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8909@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8910register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8911
8912This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8913@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8914register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8915VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8916``s0'' and ``s1''.
8917@end defmac
8918
d37d6c0b 8919@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
889fd92b 8920Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8921requires different names for the machine instructions.
8922
8923The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8924assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8925macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8926points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8927written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8928opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8929increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8930so that it will not be output twice.
8931
8932In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8933name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8934that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8935care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8936@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8937
ebf49ed9 8938@findex recog_data.operand
889fd92b 8939If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
ebf49ed9 8940elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
889fd92b 8941
8942If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8943in the usual way.
d37d6c0b 8944@end defmac
889fd92b 8945
d37d6c0b 8946@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
889fd92b 8947If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8948assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8949they will be output differently.
8950
8951Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8952extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8953elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8954The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8955template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8956by changing the contents of the vector.
8957
8958This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8959file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8960can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8961as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8962syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8963writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8964
8965If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
d37d6c0b 8966@end defmac
889fd92b 8967
18282db0 8968@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
e6554c42 8969If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8970output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8971if necessary.
8972
8973Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8974extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8975elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8976The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8977template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8978by checking the contents of the vector.
8979@end deftypefn
8980
d37d6c0b 8981@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
889fd92b 8982A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8983assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8984RTL expression.
8985
8986@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8987of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8988printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8989the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8990operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8991@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8992@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8993
8994@findex reg_names
8995If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8996The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8997@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8998@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8999
9000When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
9001(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
9002with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
9003@var{code}.
d37d6c0b 9004@end defmac
889fd92b 9005
d37d6c0b 9006@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
889fd92b 9007A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
9008punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
9009@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
9010punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
9011in this way.
d37d6c0b 9012@end defmac
889fd92b 9013
d37d6c0b 9014@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
889fd92b 9015A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
9016assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
9017whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
9018
7811991d 9019@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
889fd92b 9020On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
7811991d 9021section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
9022@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
d37d6c0b 9023@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
9024Format}.
9025@end defmac
889fd92b 9026
889fd92b 9027@findex dbr_sequence_length
d37d6c0b 9028@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
889fd92b 9029A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
9030been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
9031determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
9032currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
9033or whatever.
9034
9035Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
9036reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
0858f8a2 9037explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
d37d6c0b 9038@end defmac
889fd92b 9039
9040@findex final_sequence
9041Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
0858f8a2 9042prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
9043(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
889fd92b 9044found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
9045processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
9046being output.
9047
889fd92b 9048@findex asm_fprintf
d37d6c0b 9049@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
9050@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
9051@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
9052@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
889fd92b 9053If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
9054@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
9055@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
9056support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
9057files can define these macros differently.
d37d6c0b 9058@end defmac
889fd92b 9059
d37d6c0b 9060@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
ae7d2789 9061If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
31b6f0a8 9062statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
9063the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
9064printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
f613a8c9 9065statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
31b6f0a8 9066generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
9067specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
9068The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
9069string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
9070upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
d37d6c0b 9071@end defmac
31b6f0a8 9072
d37d6c0b 9073@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
889fd92b 9074If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
9075different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
9076numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
9077first variant.
9078
9079If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
747af5e7 9080@smallexample
228c5b30 9081@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
747af5e7 9082@end smallexample
9083@noindent
9084in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
9085first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
9086@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
9087@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
9088within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
9089alternatives within the braces than the value of
82353beb 9090@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
9091to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
9092@samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
889fd92b 9093
9094If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
9095@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
9096operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
9097
9098Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
9099@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
997d68fe 9100the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
889fd92b 9101@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
9102if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
9103opcodes or operand order.
d37d6c0b 9104@end defmac
889fd92b 9105
d37d6c0b 9106@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
889fd92b 9107A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9108which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
9109The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9110profiling.
d37d6c0b 9111@end defmac
889fd92b 9112
d37d6c0b 9113@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
889fd92b 9114A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9115which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
9116The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9117profiling.
d37d6c0b 9118@end defmac
889fd92b 9119
9120@node Dispatch Tables
9121@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
9122
9123@c prevent bad page break with this line
9124This concerns dispatch tables.
9125
889fd92b 9126@cindex dispatch table
d37d6c0b 9127@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
889fd92b 9128A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9129pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
9130@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
9131definitions of these labels are output using
805e22b2 9132@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
889fd92b 9133way here. For example,
9134
a0ecd6b1 9135@smallexample
889fd92b 9136fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
9137 @var{value}, @var{rel})
a0ecd6b1 9138@end smallexample
889fd92b 9139
9140You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
37744367 9141dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
0858e3a2 9142will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
70c2c81c 9143@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
9eaab178 9144mode and flags can be read.
d37d6c0b 9145@end defmac
889fd92b 9146
d37d6c0b 9147@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
889fd92b 9148This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
9149in a dispatch table are absolute.
9150
9151The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
9152@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
9153a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
805e22b2 9154definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
889fd92b 9155For example,
9156
a0ecd6b1 9157@smallexample
889fd92b 9158fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
a0ecd6b1 9159@end smallexample
d37d6c0b 9160@end defmac
889fd92b 9161
d37d6c0b 9162@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
889fd92b 9163Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
9164specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
805e22b2 9165@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
9ddbb404 9166jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
889fd92b 9167@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
9168
9169This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
9170for the table.
9171
9172If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
805e22b2 9173@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
d37d6c0b 9174@end defmac
889fd92b 9175
d37d6c0b 9176@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
889fd92b 9177Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
9178jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
9179after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
9180the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
9181@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
9182of the preceding label.
9183
9184If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
9185the jump-table.
d37d6c0b 9186@end defmac
889fd92b 9187
5f77f12a 9188@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
b3d47662 9189This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
2f9fc8ef 9190should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
9191should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
9192function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
ef1074f7 9193The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
9194exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
b3d47662 9195true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
2f9fc8ef 9196
9197The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
9198@end deftypefn
9199
5f77f12a 9200@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
b215c058 9201This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
9202It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
9203to be broken up according to function.
9204
9205The default is that no label is emitted.
9206@end deftypefn
9207
37966699 9208@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
9209If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
9210@end deftypefn
9211
18282db0 9212@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
5f77f12a 9213This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
cc7d6aed 9214given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9215returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
8ec87476 9216@end deftypefn
9217
f3e8e368 9218@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
9219True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
9220@end deftypevr
9221
3b0848a2 9222@node Exception Region Output
889fd92b 9223@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
9224
9225@c prevent bad page break with this line
9226
9227This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
9228region.
9229
d37d6c0b 9230@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
2cb4ac60 9231If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
9232exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
9233provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
9234@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
d757b8c9 9235
9236You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
9237unwind information and the default definition does not work.
d37d6c0b 9238@end defmac
d757b8c9 9239
552a60d3 9240@defmac EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
9241If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will identified by
9242specially named labels. The collect2 process will locate these
9243labels and generate code to register the frames.
4b6d9d50 9244
552a60d3 9245This might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker will not
9246place the eh_frames in-between the sentinals from @file{crtstuff.c},
9247or if the system linker does garbage collection and sections cannot
9248be marked as not to be collected.
d37d6c0b 9249@end defmac
4b6d9d50 9250
51601538 9251@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
9252Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
9253information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
9254runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
9255and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
9256@end defmac
9257
d37d6c0b 9258@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
70c2c81c 9259An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
889fd92b 9260that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
d37d6c0b 9261@end defmac
d757b8c9 9262
d37d6c0b 9263@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
d757b8c9 9264Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9265information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
9266Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
d8555e79 9267@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
9268GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
cc7d6aed 9269@end defmac
d757b8c9 9270
218e3e4e 9271@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
cc7d6aed 9272This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
9273by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
9274should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
9275@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
9276should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9277information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
d757b8c9 9278
cc7d6aed 9279A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
9280This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
9281default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
d757b8c9 9282
cc7d6aed 9283Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
b213bf24 9284not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
9285@var{opts}. In particular, the
cc7d6aed 9286setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
9287macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
9288depending on this setting.
9289
9290The default implementation of the hook first honors the
9291@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
b213bf24 9292@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
9293@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
9294must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
cc7d6aed 9295@end deftypefn
8ec87476 9296
218e3e4e 9297@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
1774763d 9298This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
b213bf24 9299tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
9300command-line option processing.
48a84cee 9301@end deftypevr
1774763d 9302
2c8a1497 9303@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
9304Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
9305should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
9306instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
b5813232 9307@end defmac
9308
91bb968b 9309@defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
9310This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
9311defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
9312for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
9313is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
9314The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
9315@end defmac
9316
d37d6c0b 9317@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
78ac74b9 9318This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
9319function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
9320@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
2b785411 9321alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive
78ac74b9 9322minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
9323the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
d37d6c0b 9324@end defmac
889fd92b 9325
48a84cee 9326@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
a08b74c8 9327Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
9328end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
9329Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
9330true otherwise.
48a84cee 9331@end deftypevr
a08b74c8 9332
9754a2f0 9333@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
9334Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
9335represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9336register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9337locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9338register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9339If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9340@end deftypefn
9341
3754d046 9342@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
d626297e 9343Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
9344corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally
9345used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
9346clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
9347@end deftypefn
9348
114a8a4b 9349@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9350If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9351multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9352sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9353It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9354filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9355@var{address} is the address of the table.
9356@end deftypefn
9357
1774763d 9358@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9359This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9360the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9361if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9362reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9363@end deftypefn
9364
5f77f12a 9365@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9366This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
1774763d 9367based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9368the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9369running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
5f77f12a 9370@end deftypevr
1774763d 9371
889fd92b 9372@node Alignment Output
9373@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9374
9375@c prevent bad page break with this line
9376This describes commands for alignment.
9377
d37d6c0b 9378@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
312866af 9379The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8ef587dc 9380a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9a21c785 9381
9382This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9383to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9384define the macro.
61e95947 9385
e6c99545 9386Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9387to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
cc5d3821 9388@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
312866af 9389selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
d37d6c0b 9390@end defmac
312866af 9391
695d0571 9392@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
ae2b9f1f 9393The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9394@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9395@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9396@end deftypefn
9397
d37d6c0b 9398@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
312866af 9399The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9400a @code{BARRIER}.
9401
9402This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9403to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9404define the macro.
d37d6c0b 9405@end defmac
e6c99545 9406
695d0571 9407@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
ae2b9f1f 9408The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
61e95947 9409@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9410@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ae2b9f1f 9411@end deftypefn
61e95947 9412
d37d6c0b 9413@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
720b223d 9414The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9415a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
889fd92b 9416
9417This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9418to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9419define the macro.
9420
61e95947 9421Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
70c2c81c 9422to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
cc5d3821 9423@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
70c2c81c 9424selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
d37d6c0b 9425@end defmac
61e95947 9426
695d0571 9427@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
ae2b9f1f 9428The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9429@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9430defined.
9431@end deftypefn
61e95947 9432
d37d6c0b 9433@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
21d55c67 9434The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
70c2c81c 9435If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
21d55c67 9436the maximum of the specified values is used.
9437
61e95947 9438Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
70c2c81c 9439to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
cc5d3821 9440@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
70c2c81c 9441selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
d37d6c0b 9442@end defmac
61e95947 9443
695d0571 9444@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
ae2b9f1f 9445The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9446to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9447is defined.
9448@end deftypefn
61e95947 9449
d37d6c0b 9450@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
889fd92b 9451A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9452instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9453Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
819bacb1 9454expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
d37d6c0b 9455@end defmac
889fd92b 9456
d37d6c0b 9457@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
889fd92b 9458Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
da2b9be0 9459text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
889fd92b 9460This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9461produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9462section.
d37d6c0b 9463@end defmac
889fd92b 9464
d37d6c0b 9465@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
889fd92b 9466A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9467command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9468@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
d37d6c0b 9469@end defmac
7e4ec8d5 9470
d37d6c0b 9471@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
7af58cc3 9472Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9473for padding, if necessary.
d37d6c0b 9474@end defmac
7af58cc3 9475
d37d6c0b 9476@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
7e4ec8d5 9477A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9478command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9479@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9480satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9481a C expression of type @code{int}.
d37d6c0b 9482@end defmac
889fd92b 9483
9484@need 3000
9485@node Debugging Info
9486@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9487
9488@c prevent bad page break with this line
9489This describes how to specify debugging information.
9490
9491@menu
9492* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9493* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9494* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9495* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9496* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
e6307525 9497* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
889fd92b 9498@end menu
9499
9500@node All Debuggers
9501@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9502
9503@c prevent bad page break with this line
9504These macros affect all debugging formats.
9505
d37d6c0b 9506@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
889fd92b 9507A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
1ff6063a 9508register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9509of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9510some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9511versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9512compiler and another for DBX@.
889fd92b 9513
e8e57187 9514If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
889fd92b 9515used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9516consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9517Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9518expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9519
9520If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9521does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9522redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
d37d6c0b 9523@end defmac
889fd92b 9524
d37d6c0b 9525@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
889fd92b 9526A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9527variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9528computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9529gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9530that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9531for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
8ae77b3c 9532@option{-g} options is used.
d37d6c0b 9533@end defmac
889fd92b 9534
d37d6c0b 9535@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
889fd92b 9536A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9537having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9538@var{offset}.
d37d6c0b 9539@end defmac
889fd92b 9540
d37d6c0b 9541@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
e8e57187 9542A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
8ae77b3c 9543produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
e8e57187 9544this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
997d68fe 9545debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
e6307525 9546@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9547@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
889fd92b 9548
8ae77b3c 9549When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
997d68fe 9550value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
f254cd4c 9551exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
997d68fe 9552value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
e8e57187 9553defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
0c10f15a 9554
889fd92b 9555The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
8ae77b3c 9556user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
ad8d48ea 9557@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
d37d6c0b 9558@end defmac
889fd92b 9559
9560@node DBX Options
9561@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9562
9563@c prevent bad page break with this line
9564These are specific options for DBX output.
9565
d37d6c0b 9566@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
e8e57187 9567Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
8ae77b3c 9568in response to the @option{-g} option.
d37d6c0b 9569@end defmac
889fd92b 9570
d37d6c0b 9571@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
e8e57187 9572Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
8ae77b3c 9573in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
d37d6c0b 9574@end defmac
889fd92b 9575
d37d6c0b 9576@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
e8e57187 9577Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
889fd92b 9578GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9579debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9580macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9581if there is any occasion to.
d37d6c0b 9582@end defmac
889fd92b 9583
d37d6c0b 9584@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
889fd92b 9585Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9586in the text section.
d37d6c0b 9587@end defmac
889fd92b 9588
d37d6c0b 9589@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
b01e21ca 9590A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9591use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9592If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9593applies only to DBX debugging information format.
d37d6c0b 9594@end defmac
889fd92b 9595
d37d6c0b 9596@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
b01e21ca 9597A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9598use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9599value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9600@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9601information format.
d37d6c0b 9602@end defmac
889fd92b 9603
d37d6c0b 9604@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
b01e21ca 9605A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9606use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9607name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9608macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
d37d6c0b 9609@end defmac
889fd92b 9610
d37d6c0b 9611@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
889fd92b 9612Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9613@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9614describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9615On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
d37d6c0b 9616@end defmac
889fd92b 9617
d37d6c0b 9618@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
889fd92b 9619A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9620continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9621exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9622operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9623must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9624with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9625defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
d37d6c0b 9626@end defmac
889fd92b 9627
d37d6c0b 9628@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
889fd92b 9629Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9630the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9631a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9632constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9633if backslash is correct for your system.
d37d6c0b 9634@end defmac
889fd92b 9635
d37d6c0b 9636@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
889fd92b 9637Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9638outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9639variable.
d37d6c0b 9640@end defmac
889fd92b 9641
d37d6c0b 9642@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
889fd92b 9643The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9644for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
d37d6c0b 9645@end defmac
889fd92b 9646
d37d6c0b 9647@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
889fd92b 9648The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9649for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9650provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
d37d6c0b 9651@end defmac
889fd92b 9652
d37d6c0b 9653@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
889fd92b 9654The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9655for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9656``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
d37d6c0b 9657@end defmac
889fd92b 9658
d37d6c0b 9659@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
889fd92b 9660The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9661passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9662do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
d37d6c0b 9663@end defmac
889fd92b 9664
d37d6c0b 9665@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
889fd92b 9666Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9667arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9668in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9669code.
d37d6c0b 9670@end defmac
889fd92b 9671
d37d6c0b 9672@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
e3b8b697 9673Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9674the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9675relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9676an absolute address.
9677@end defmac
9678
9679@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9680Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9681the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9682start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
d37d6c0b 9683@end defmac
889fd92b 9684
d37d6c0b 9685@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
37744367 9686Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
889fd92b 9687@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
37744367 9688macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9689number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
889fd92b 9690generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9691number for a type number.
d37d6c0b 9692@end defmac
889fd92b 9693
9694@node DBX Hooks
9695@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9696
9697@c prevent bad page break with this line
9698These are hooks for DBX format.
9699
e3b8b697 9700@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9701A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9702number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
b3d47662 9703@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
e3b8b697 9704invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9705unique labels in the assembly output.
9706
9707This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9708if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9709@end defmac
9710
d37d6c0b 9711@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
889fd92b 9712Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
8e5fcce7 9713@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
889fd92b 9714On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9715disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
d37d6c0b 9716@end defmac
889fd92b 9717
7d6171f2 9718@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9719Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9720extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9721feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9722@end defmac
9723
889fd92b 9724@node File Names and DBX
9725@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9726
9727@c prevent bad page break with this line
9728This describes file names in DBX format.
9729
d37d6c0b 9730@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
889fd92b 9731A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
d0de818d 9732@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
889fd92b 9733file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9734This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9735
9736This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9737for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
d0de818d 9738
9739It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9740text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9741to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9742@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
d37d6c0b 9743@end defmac
889fd92b 9744
d0de818d 9745@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9746Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9747of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9748the beginning of the file.
9749@end defmac
889fd92b 9750
d0de818d 9751@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9752Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9753that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9754an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9755@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
d37d6c0b 9756@end defmac
889fd92b 9757
d37d6c0b 9758@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
889fd92b 9759A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
d0de818d 9760compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9761written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
889fd92b 9762
9763If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9764of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
d37d6c0b 9765@end defmac
889fd92b 9766
e3b8b697 9767@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9768Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9769@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
68576faf 9770the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
e3b8b697 9771whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9772@end defmac
9773
889fd92b 9774@need 2000
9775@node SDB and DWARF
9776@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9777
9778@c prevent bad page break with this line
9779Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9780
d37d6c0b 9781@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
2e3b03ce 9782Define this macro to 1 if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
8ae77b3c 9783for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
d37d6c0b 9784@end defmac
889fd92b 9785
d37d6c0b 9786@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
e8e57187 9787Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
8ae77b3c 9788debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
3c4f45fb 9789
ddc6a57f 9790@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
8ff30ff6 9791Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9792be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9793value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9794@end deftypefn
9795
071cd279 9796To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9797define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9798@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9799prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
17d9b0c3 9800as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
d37d6c0b 9801@end defmac
071cd279 9802
d37d6c0b 9803@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
e8e57187 9804Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
cc7d6aed 9805Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9806(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9807exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9808how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
d37d6c0b 9809@end defmac
9e042f31 9810
cc7d6aed 9811@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9812This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9813unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9814@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9815return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9816
9817A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9818is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9819
9820A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9821This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9822@end deftypefn
9823
d37d6c0b 9824@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
985956c1 9825Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9826line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9827tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
d37d6c0b 9828@end defmac
985956c1 9829
1651aa77 9830@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9831True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9832@end deftypevr
9833
8a42230a 9834@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
84b574d2 9835True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.
9836This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
8a42230a 9837@end deftypevr
9838
9839@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
84b574d2 9840True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.
9841This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9842@end deftypevr
9843
9844@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION
9845True if register allocation and the passes
9846following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler
9847targets.
8a42230a 9848@end deftypevr
9849
d37d6c0b 9850@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
a08b74c8 9851A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
d08d29c0 9852@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
d37d6c0b 9853@end defmac
a08b74c8 9854
cfe7b52e 9855@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9856A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9857between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9858slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9859@end defmac
9860
e1719e76 9861@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{offset}, @var{section})
a08b74c8 9862A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
e1719e76 9863section-relative reference to the given @var{label} plus @var{offset}, using
9864an integer of the given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the
9865given @var{section}.
d37d6c0b 9866@end defmac
a08b74c8 9867
d37d6c0b 9868@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
a08b74c8 9869A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
d08d29c0 9870reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
d37d6c0b 9871@end defmac
a08b74c8 9872
552a60d3 9873@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DATAREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9874A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to the
9875given @var{label} relative to the dbase, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9876@end defmac
9877
912df756 9878@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9879A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9880the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9881is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9882is referenced by a function.
9883@end defmac
9884
5f77f12a 9885@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
40af64cc 9886If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9887reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9888@end deftypefn
9889
d37d6c0b 9890@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
889fd92b 9891Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9892SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9893macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9894not define them yourself.
d37d6c0b 9895@end defmac
889fd92b 9896
d37d6c0b 9897@defmac SDB_DELIM
889fd92b 9898Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9899SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9900delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9901a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9902required.
d37d6c0b 9903@end defmac
889fd92b 9904
d37d6c0b 9905@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
889fd92b 9906Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9907union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9908allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9909it.
d37d6c0b 9910@end defmac
889fd92b 9911
d37d6c0b 9912@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
889fd92b 9913Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9914enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9915assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
d37d6c0b 9916@end defmac
889fd92b 9917
e3b8b697 9918@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9919A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9920number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9921@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9922@end defmac
9923
e6307525 9924@need 2000
9925@node VMS Debug
9926@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9927
9928@c prevent bad page break with this line
9929Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9930
d37d6c0b 9931@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
e6307525 9932Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9933in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9934is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9935@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
02e53c17 9936behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
cc5d3821 9937@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
d37d6c0b 9938@end defmac
e6307525 9939
badfe841 9940@node Floating Point
889fd92b 9941@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9942@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9943@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9944
badfe841 9945While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
889fd92b 9946there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9947means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9948in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9949doing the compilation.
9950
889fd92b 9951Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
badfe841 9952range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9953the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9954safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9955the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9956emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9957target floating point formats are identical.
9958
9959The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9960use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
4268f174 9961floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9962their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
889fd92b 9963
badfe841 9964@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9965The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9966machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9967array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9968quantity.
9969@end defmac
9970
badfe841 9971@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9972Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9973@end deftypefn
9974
9975@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9976Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9977@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9978@end deftypefn
9979
3754d046 9980@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode})
badfe841 9981Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9982representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9983decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9984defined by the C language for both.
9985@end deftypefn
889fd92b 9986
536f5fb1 9987@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
fa2b6990 9988Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
536f5fb1 9989@end deftypefn
9990
badfe841 9991@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9992Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9993@end deftypefn
9994
9995@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9996Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9997@end deftypefn
9998
badfe841 9999@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10000Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
10001@end deftypefn
10002
536f5fb1 10003@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10004Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
10005@end deftypefn
10006
18862b5a 10007@node Mode Switching
10008@section Mode Switching Instructions
10009@cindex mode switching
10010The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
10011
d37d6c0b 10012@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
18862b5a 10013Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
10014switching in an optimizing compilation.
10015
10016For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
10017floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
10018the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
10019operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
10020purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
fcd8b5ad 10021be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you cannot put this into instruction emitting
2efea8c0 10022or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
18862b5a 10023
10024You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
10025which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
7120b8b4 10026return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
18862b5a 10027If you define this macro, you also have to define
cea19dab 10028@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
10029@code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
10030@code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
894b8fd9 10031are optional.
d37d6c0b 10032@end defmac
18862b5a 10033
d37d6c0b 10034@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
18862b5a 10035If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
10036initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
10037N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
10038of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
01e3cadf 10039The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
10040zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
18862b5a 10041entity in question.
10042In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
8ae77b3c 10043represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
18862b5a 10044switch is needed / supplied.
d37d6c0b 10045@end defmac
18862b5a 10046
7fc0df2f 10047@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
10048Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
cea19dab 10049@end deftypefn
18862b5a 10050
18282db0 10051@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
7fc0df2f 10052@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
cea19dab 10053@end deftypefn
894b8fd9 10054
18282db0 10055@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
cea19dab 10056@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
10057@end deftypefn
894b8fd9 10058
cea19dab 10059@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
10060If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
10061@end deftypefn
18862b5a 10062
cea19dab 10063@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
10064If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
10065@end deftypefn
18862b5a 10066
cea19dab 10067@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
10068This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
10069@end deftypefn
18862b5a 10070
e3c541f0 10071@node Target Attributes
10072@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
10073@cindex target attributes
10074@cindex machine attributes
10075@cindex attributes, target-specific
10076
10077Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
10078These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
10079be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
10080
10081@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
10082If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
91302006 10083attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine
e3c541f0 10084specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
10085entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
10086take.
10087@end deftypevr
10088
47b19b94 10089@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
10090If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
10091machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
10092given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
10093subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
10094false for all machine-specific attributes.
10095@end deftypefn
10096
ddc6a57f 10097@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
e3c541f0 10098If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
10099@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
10100and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
10101generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
10102supposed always to be compatible.
10103@end deftypefn
10104
10105@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
10106If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
5f77f12a 10107the newly defined @var{type}.
e3c541f0 10108@end deftypefn
10109
10110@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
10111Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
10112handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10113@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
10114that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
10115function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
10116merging.
10117@end deftypefn
10118
10119@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
10120Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
10121handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10122@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
10123@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
10124when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
10125attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
10126call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
10127
10128@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
3aa0c315 10129If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
10130for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
10131@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
10132will then define a function called
10133@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
10134the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
10135add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
10136to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
10137@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
10138@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
e3c541f0 10139@end deftypefn
10140
ddc6a57f 10141@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
202d6e5f 10142@var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
6c1e551f 10143@end deftypefn
10144
3c5c992f 10145@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
91e3095e 10146Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
3c5c992f 10147@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
10148default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
10149@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
10150of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
10151on this implementation detail.
10152@end defmac
10153
e3c541f0 10154@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
10155Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
10156when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
10157wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
10158the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
10159created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
10160for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
10161shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
10162the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
10163attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
10164needed.
10165@end deftypefn
10166
24833e1a 10167@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
e3c541f0 10168@cindex inlining
88eebb49 10169This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
e3c541f0 10170into the current function, despite its having target-specific
10171attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
10172target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
10173@end deftypefn
10174
5f77f12a 10175@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
090eadfb 10176This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
10177allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
10178These function-specific options may differ
10179from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
46f8e3b0 10180@code{true} if the options are valid.
10181
090eadfb 10182The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
10183the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
10184@code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
46f8e3b0 10185@end deftypefn
10186
55310327 10187@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
090eadfb 10188This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
10189in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
55310327 10190options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
46f8e3b0 10191@xref{Option file format}.
10192@end deftypefn
10193
55310327 10194@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
090eadfb 10195This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
10196information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
55310327 10197function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
46f8e3b0 10198@end deftypefn
10199
ff7cb116 10200@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10201This hook is called to update target-specific information in the
10202@code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from
10203LTO bytecode.
10204@end deftypefn
10205
294f8d57 10206@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
090eadfb 10207This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
10208information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10209function-specific options.
46f8e3b0 10210@end deftypefn
10211
04f989af 10212@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
090eadfb 10213This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
10214sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
10215input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
04f989af 10216@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
46f8e3b0 10217@end deftypefn
10218
cc5d3821 10219@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
10220Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
10221a particular target machine. You can override the hook
10222@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
10223once just after all the command options have been parsed.
10224
10225Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
02e53c17 10226@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
cc5d3821 10227
10228If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
10229changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
10230@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
10231@end deftypefn
10232
cc8ef84f 10233@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10234This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
10235versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
10236versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
10237different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
10238different target machines.
10239@end deftypefn
10240
46f8e3b0 10241@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
10242This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
10243cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
10244default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
10245specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
10246@end deftypefn
10247
9d0e3e3a 10248@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RELAYOUT_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl})
10249This target hook fixes function @var{fndecl} after attributes are processed. Default does nothing. On ARM, the default function's alignment is updated with the attribute target.
10250@end deftypefn
10251
38475469 10252@node Emulated TLS
10253@section Emulating TLS
10254@cindex Emulated TLS
10255
10256For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
10257specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
10258used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
10259configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
91f54ca3 10260the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
38475469 10261layer.
10262
10263The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
10264object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
10265which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
10266address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
10267
10268@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
10269Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
10270object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
10271emulated TLS helper function to be used.
10272@end deftypevr
10273
10274@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
10275Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
10276program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
10277initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
10278have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
10279registration function to be used.
10280@end deftypevr
10281
10282@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
10283Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
10284be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
10285any section.
10286@end deftypevr
10287
10288@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
10289Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
10290placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
10291section.
10292@end deftypevr
10293
10294@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
10295Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
10296The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10297@end deftypevr
10298
10299@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
10300Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
10301default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10302@end deftypevr
10303
10304@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10305Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10306object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10307@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10308@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
10309for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10310@end deftypefn
10311
10312@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10313Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10314TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10315is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10316initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10317@end deftypefn
10318
ddc6a57f 10319@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
38475469 10320Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10321fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10322single objects. The default is false.
10323@end deftypevr
10324
ddc6a57f 10325@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
38475469 10326Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10327may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10328@end deftypevr
10329
8d85666f 10330@node MIPS Coprocessors
10331@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10332@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10333
10334The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
ef8d967c 10335coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
8d85666f 10336accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10337and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10338
10339@smallexample
10340 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10341 unsigned int d;
10342
10343 d = cp0count + 3;
10344@end smallexample
10345
10346(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10347names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10348overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10349
10350Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10351be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10352later in the function.
10353
10354Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
b3d47662 10355the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
8d85666f 10356floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10357
7988d6e2 10358@node PCH Target
10359@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10360@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10361
836c5cf2 10362@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
5f77f12a 10363This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10364@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
836c5cf2 10365@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
7988d6e2 10366@end deftypefn
10367
ddc6a57f 10368@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
761d9126 10369This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10370compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10371if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10372be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10373
10374@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10375when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10376It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10377compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10378
10379The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10380suitable for most targets.
10381@end deftypefn
10382
ddc6a57f 10383@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
761d9126 10384If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10385@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10386of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10387@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10388value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
7988d6e2 10389@end deftypefn
10390
e5d92c9b 10391@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10392Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10393garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10394it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10395to do anything here.
10396@end deftypefn
10397
c1dc02de 10398@node C++ ABI
10399@section C++ ABI parameters
10400@cindex parameters, c++ abi
10401
10402@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10403Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10404These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10405default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10406@end deftypefn
10407
10408@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
9e7454d0 10409This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
5f77f12a 10410@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10411@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
c1dc02de 10412@end deftypefn
10413
600f4be7 10414@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10415This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10416whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10417known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10418@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
b3d47662 10419IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
600f4be7 10420@end deftypefn
10421
10422@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10423This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10424array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10425@end deftypefn
10426
202d6e5f 10427@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
52d6bee4 10428If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10429class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
01e3cadf 10430will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
52d6bee4 10431to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10432modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10433backend's targeted operating system.
10434@end deftypefn
10435
853b7640 10436@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10437This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10438the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10439@code{false}.
10440@end deftypefn
10441
219626ad 10442@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10443This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10444which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10445table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10446Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10447the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10448some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10449method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10450@end deftypefn
10451
7908506d 10452@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
202d6e5f 10453@var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
7908506d 10454@end deftypefn
10455
10456@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10457This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10458similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10459external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10460classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10461unit will not be COMDAT.
4fc9a8ec 10462@end deftypefn
10463
60d9461b 10464@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10465This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10466the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10467be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10468@end deftypefn
10469
46b9ff5e 10470@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10471This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10472should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10473is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10474@end deftypefn
10475
d91ef9b0 10476@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10477This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10478in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10479destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10480shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10481unloaded. The default is to return false.
10482@end deftypefn
10483
6c1e551f 10484@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
202d6e5f 10485@var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
6c1e551f 10486@end deftypefn
10487
16a1895e 10488@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10489Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10490@end deftypefn
10491
bd1a81f7 10492@node Named Address Spaces
10493@section Adding support for named address spaces
10494@cindex named address spaces
10495
10496The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10497standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10498support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10499processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10500GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10501address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10502spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10503@code{const} type attributes.
10504
882f66bc 10505Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
bd1a81f7 10506pointers to the generic address space.
10507
10508For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10509to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10510processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10511issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10512local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10513address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10514@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10515always 32 bits).
10516
10517Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10518range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10519address space.
10520
34208e18 10521To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10522the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10523the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10524named address space #1:
6d5d708e 10525@smallexample
10526#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
34208e18 10527c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
6d5d708e 10528@end smallexample
6d5d708e 10529
f77c4496 10530@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
98155838 10531Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10532@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
dd7df208 10533The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode}.
98155838 10534@end deftypefn
10535
f77c4496 10536@deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
98155838 10537Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10538@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
dd7df208 10539The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode}.
98155838 10540@end deftypefn
10541
f77c4496 10542@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (scalar_int_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
98155838 10543Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10544with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10545hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10546except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10547version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10548@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10549target hooks for the given address space.
10550@end deftypefn
10551
3754d046 10552@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
bd1a81f7 10553Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10554@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10555parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10556finished. This target hook is the same as the
10557@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10558explicit named address space support.
10559@end deftypefn
10560
3754d046 10561@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
bd1a81f7 10562Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10563with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10564hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10565except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10566@end deftypefn
10567
d384d9d9 10568@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
bd1a81f7 10569Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10570contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10571a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10572will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10573arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
b6a556f8 10574converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
bd1a81f7 10575@end deftypefn
10576
9cb89654 10577@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ZERO_ADDRESS_VALID (addr_space_t @var{as})
10578Define this to modify the default handling of address 0 for the
10579address space. Return true if 0 should be considered a valid address.
10580@end deftypefn
10581
ddc6a57f 10582@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
bd1a81f7 10583Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10584@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10585space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10586to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10587guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10588as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10589@end deftypefn
10590
2e7a553a 10591@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DEBUG (addr_space_t @var{as})
10592Define this to define how the address space is encoded in dwarf.
10593The result is the value to be used with @code{DW_AT_address_class}.
10594@end deftypefn
10595
a91a5f8a 10596@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DIAGNOSE_USAGE (addr_space_t @var{as}, location_t @var{loc})
10597Define this hook if the availability of an address space depends on
10598command line options and some diagnostics should be printed when the
10599address space is used. This hook is called during parsing and allows
10600to emit a better diagnostic compared to the case where the address space
10601was not registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}. @var{as} is
10602the address space as registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}.
10603@var{loc} is the location of the address space qualifier token.
10604The default implementation does nothing.
10605@end deftypefn
10606
889fd92b 10607@node Misc
10608@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10609@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10610
10611@c prevent bad page break with this line
10612Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10613
cbf464bd 10614@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10615Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10616has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10617conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10618blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10619set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10620to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10621@end defmac
10622
10623@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10624Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10625has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10626conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10627blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10628set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10629to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
d37d6c0b 10630@end defmac
3a074b0f 10631
d37d6c0b 10632@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
889fd92b 10633An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10634elements of a jump-table should have.
d37d6c0b 10635@end defmac
889fd92b 10636
d37d6c0b 10637@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
9eaab178 10638Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10639when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10640it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
a22d2169 10641To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
9eaab178 10642make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
b2778e49 10643The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
9eaab178 10644flags can be updated.
d37d6c0b 10645@end defmac
9eaab178 10646
d37d6c0b 10647@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
25d1d1e9 10648Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
745f3229 10649should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10650jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10651contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10652is in effect.
d37d6c0b 10653@end defmac
889fd92b 10654
ddc6a57f 10655@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
906bb5c3 10656This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
889fd92b 10657is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10658The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10659five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
906bb5c3 10660@end deftypefn
889fd92b 10661
d37d6c0b 10662@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
94f1fba7 10663Define this macro to 1 if operations between registers with integral mode
889fd92b 10664smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10665Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
d37d6c0b 10666@end defmac
889fd92b 10667
97574c57 10668@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_ARITHMETIC_PRECISION (void)
10669On some RISC architectures with 64-bit registers, the processor also
10670maintains 32-bit condition codes that make it possible to do real 32-bit
10671arithmetic, although the operations are performed on the full registers.
10672
10673On such architectures, defining this hook to 32 tells the compiler to try
10674using 32-bit arithmetical operations setting the condition codes instead
10675of doing full 64-bit arithmetic.
10676
10677More generally, define this hook on RISC architectures if you want the
10678compiler to try using arithmetical operations setting the condition codes
10679with a precision lower than the word precision.
10680
10681You need not define this hook if @code{WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS} is not
10682defined to 1.
10683@end deftypefn
10684
a091e4f5 10685@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
889fd92b 10686Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
a091e4f5 10687memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10688bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
889fd92b 10689zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
a091e4f5 10690of @var{mem_mode} for which the
889fd92b 10691insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
21f1e711 10692@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
889fd92b 10693
a091e4f5 10694This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
889fd92b 10695greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10696value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
21f1e711 10697@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
889fd92b 10698define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
a091e4f5 10699
21f1e711 10700You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
a091e4f5 10701the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10702of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10703when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10704integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10705
21f1e711 10706You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
a091e4f5 10707mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10708@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10709is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
d37d6c0b 10710@end defmac
889fd92b 10711
d37d6c0b 10712@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
d0b99710 10713Define this macro to 1 if loading short immediate values into registers sign
7eee1371 10714extends.
d37d6c0b 10715@end defmac
7eee1371 10716
3754d046 10717@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode})
ac70caad 10718When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10719divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10720the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10721that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10722of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10723has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10724@end deftypefn
10725
d37d6c0b 10726@defmac MOVE_MAX
889fd92b 10727The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10728between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
d37d6c0b 10729@end defmac
889fd92b 10730
d37d6c0b 10731@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
889fd92b 10732The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10733between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10734is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10735constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10736at run-time.
d37d6c0b 10737@end defmac
889fd92b 10738
d37d6c0b 10739@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
889fd92b 10740A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10741actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10742of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
f45856ef 10743this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
889fd92b 10744a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10745truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
8e5fcce7 10746instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
889fd92b 10747include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10748also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
8e5fcce7 10749arguments to bit-field instructions.
889fd92b 10750
10751If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
8e5fcce7 10752position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
889fd92b 10753instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10754
10755However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10756only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
8e5fcce7 10757bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
889fd92b 10758such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10759the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10760
10761You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
d37d6c0b 10762@end defmac
889fd92b 10763
c49547c4 10764@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
3754d046 10765@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode})
c49547c4 10766This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10767deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10768@xref{shift patterns}.
10769
10770On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10771shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10772equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10773this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10774otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10775particular behavior is guaranteed.
10776
10777Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10778@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10779that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10780
10781The default implementation of this function returns
10782@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10783and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10784@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10785nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10786by overriding it.
10787@end deftypefn
10788
d37d6c0b 10789@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
889fd92b 10790A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10791``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10792bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10793operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10794
10795On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10796
10797@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10798@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10799When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10800modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10801If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10802such cases may improve things.
d37d6c0b 10803@end defmac
889fd92b 10804
f77c4496 10805@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (scalar_int_mode @var{mode}, scalar_int_mode @var{rep_mode})
4562961a 10806The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
4956440a 10807are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10808@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10809sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10810otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10811representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10812@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10813@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
5f77f12a 10814@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
4956440a 10815widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10816
10817Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10818value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10819as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10820@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10821
10822Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10823describe two related properties. If you define
10824@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10825to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10826extension.
10827
10828In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10829@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10830@code{mode}.
10831@end deftypefn
10832
d37d6c0b 10833@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
889fd92b 10834A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10835with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
56bf9283 10836(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10837apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
889fd92b 10838comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10839
8ae77b3c 10840A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10841comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
889fd92b 10842and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10843which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10844true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10845operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
56bf9283 10846@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
889fd92b 10847@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10848the compiler.
10849
8ae77b3c 10850If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
889fd92b 10851generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10852replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10853the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10854For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10855@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10856@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10857expression
10858
10859@smallexample
10860(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10861@end smallexample
10862
10863@noindent
10864can be converted to
10865
10866@smallexample
10867(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10868@end smallexample
10869
10870@noindent
10871where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10872tested into the sign bit.
10873
10874There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10875for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10876but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
e8e57187 10877are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
889fd92b 10878perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
f5b36051 10879comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
889fd92b 10880
10881Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10882from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10883choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10884to be used:
10885
10886@itemize @bullet
10887@item
10888Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10889@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10890``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10891comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10892combine the normalization with other operations.
10893
10894@item
8ae77b3c 10895For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
889fd92b 10896slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10897other machines.
10898
10899@item
10900As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10901exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10902others.
10903
10904@item
10905Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10906@end itemize
10907
10908Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10909@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10910instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10911those cases, e.g., one matching
10912
10913@smallexample
10914(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10915@end smallexample
10916
10917Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10918condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
56bf9283 10919@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
889fd92b 10920machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10921and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10922@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
b59688ee 10923@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
889fd92b 10924find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10925
194b1cc5 10926If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10927not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10928instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
d37d6c0b 10929@end defmac
889fd92b 10930
d37d6c0b 10931@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
f45856ef 10932A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
889fd92b 10933returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
7be10878 10934Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
889fd92b 10935floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10936this macro.
d37d6c0b 10937@end defmac
889fd92b 10938
7be10878 10939@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
3ce7ff97 10940A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
7be10878 10941for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10942mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10943this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10944return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10945this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10946@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10947the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10948given mode.
10949@end defmac
10950
d37d6c0b 10951@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10952@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
e533b20e 10953A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
15b474a2 10954for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
e533b20e 10955A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10956If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10957evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10958entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
15b474a2 10959the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
e533b20e 10960In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
15b474a2 10961this value.
e533b20e 10962
10963If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10964@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
8f4be2be 10965
10966This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10967relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
e533b20e 10968is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10969to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
8f4be2be 10970
10971Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10972and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10973visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10974to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
b3d47662 10975breaking the API@.
d37d6c0b 10976@end defmac
8f4be2be 10977
d37d6c0b 10978@defmac Pmode
889fd92b 10979An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10980this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10981pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10982On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10983modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10984
10985The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10986@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10987@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10988to @code{Pmode}.
d37d6c0b 10989@end defmac
889fd92b 10990
d37d6c0b 10991@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
889fd92b 10992An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
8995c1df 10993being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
15b474a2 10994where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
8995c1df 10995@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10996size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10997as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
d37d6c0b 10998@end defmac
889fd92b 10999
d37d6c0b 11000@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
7251c7e8 11001In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
11002constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
11003hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
11004where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
11005strict conformance to the C Standard.
11006
11007Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
11008convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
11009files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
d37d6c0b 11010@end defmac
7251c7e8 11011
6adc88f8 11012@deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
11013Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
11014
11015 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
11016@end deftypefn
11017
f9f68d35 11018@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
11019Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
11020@end deftypefn
11021
d37d6c0b 11022@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
0858e3a2 11023Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
889fd92b 11024This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
11025C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
11026@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
d37d6c0b 11027@end defmac
889fd92b 11028
889fd92b 11029@findex #pragma
11030@findex pragma
d37d6c0b 11031@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
1fcd08b1 11032Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
c6f14ce5 11033If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
68bf2ad9 11034@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
11035for each pragma. The macro may also do any
c6f14ce5 11036setup required for the pragmas.
1fcd08b1 11037
11038The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
11039other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
0858e3a2 11040definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
889fd92b 11041
747af5e7 11042If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
e3c541f0 11043defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
2f491b41 11044
1fcd08b1 11045Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
11046@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
8ae77b3c 11047silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
d37d6c0b 11048@end defmac
1fcd08b1 11049
eb180587 11050@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
68bf2ad9 11051@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
1fcd08b1 11052
68bf2ad9 11053Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
11054@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
1fcd08b1 11055@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
11056pragma of the form
11057
11058@smallexample
11059#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
11060@end smallexample
11061
c6f14ce5 11062@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
11063@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
11064routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10cac3d7 11065on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
b5d533bb 11066@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10cac3d7 11067callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
68bf2ad9 11068a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
11069arguments of pragmas registered with
11070@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
11071pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
1fcd08b1 11072
b5d533bb 11073Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
8daa9e98 11074compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
b5d533bb 11075other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
8daa9e98 11076to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
8e5fcce7 11077building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
8daa9e98 11078variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
70c2c81c 11079target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
8daa9e98 11080the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
b5d533bb 11081code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
8daa9e98 11082rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
11083how to build this object file.
1fcd08b1 11084@end deftypefun
11085
68bf2ad9 11086@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
3e0e49f2 11087Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
68bf2ad9 11088arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
11089@end defmac
11090
6b5553e5 11091@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
11092If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
837bbb8b 11093the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
300c667a 11094This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
6b5553e5 11095@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
11096@end defmac
11097
d37d6c0b 11098@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
14e33bb6 11099Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
d7518d5f 11100identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
14e33bb6 11101not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
11102there is no need to define this macro in that case.
d37d6c0b 11103@end defmac
889fd92b 11104
d37d6c0b 11105@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
889fd92b 11106Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11107delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11108even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
e8e57187 11109@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
889fd92b 11110every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
11111or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
11112you should define this macro.
11113
11114You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
d37d6c0b 11115@end defmac
889fd92b 11116
d37d6c0b 11117@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
889fd92b 11118Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11119delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11120even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
11121@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
11122some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
11123are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
11124define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
11125instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
11126slot of @var{insn}.
11127
11128You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
d37d6c0b 11129@end defmac
889fd92b 11130
d37d6c0b 11131@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
197e583a 11132Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
11133global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
11134symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
11135instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
11136from shared libraries (DLLs).
11137
11138You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
d37d6c0b 11139@end defmac
071cd279 11140
2af3d775 11141@deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs})
11142This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and
11143@var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically
11144clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected
11145to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.
11146
11147It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}
11148as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is
11149a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.
0fb2666c 11150@end deftypefn
b83e57f8 11151
d37d6c0b 11152@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
e6a3070d 11153Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
cb22f930 11154in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
11155@samp{""} if the target does not have a
e6a3070d 11156separate math library.
11157
cb22f930 11158You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
d37d6c0b 11159@end defmac
397f1574 11160
d37d6c0b 11161@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
397f1574 11162Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
11163specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
11164
11165You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
11166is wrong.
d37d6c0b 11167@end defmac
255b8f3f 11168
6073aca2 11169@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
11170Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
11171functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
11172Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
255b8f3f 11173to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
6073aca2 11174if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
ffb2b2b7 11175for cross-profiling.
d37d6c0b 11176@end defmac
406034fa 11177
d37d6c0b 11178@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
406034fa 11179
11180A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
11181conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
11182@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
111831 if it does use cc0.
d37d6c0b 11184@end defmac
7efd6cf1 11185
d37d6c0b 11186@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
1d855d4c 11187Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
11188conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
11189@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
11190contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
11191and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
11192then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
11193@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
d37d6c0b 11194@end defmac
1d855d4c 11195
d37d6c0b 11196@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
1d855d4c 11197Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
11198if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
11199@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
11200being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
d37d6c0b 11201@end defmac
7efd6cf1 11202
d37d6c0b 11203@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
1d855d4c 11204A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
11205be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
11206a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
11207about the currently processed blocks.
d37d6c0b 11208@end defmac
7efd6cf1 11209
d37d6c0b 11210@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
7efd6cf1 11211A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
1d855d4c 11212converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11213can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11214to by @var{ce_info}.
d37d6c0b 11215@end defmac
7efd6cf1 11216
d37d6c0b 11217@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
7efd6cf1 11218A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
1d855d4c 11219converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11220can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11221to by @var{ce_info}.
d37d6c0b 11222@end defmac
1d855d4c 11223
e2ca32a4 11224@defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
11225A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
11226of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11227to by @var{ce_info}.
d37d6c0b 11228@end defmac
1d855d4c 11229
ddc6a57f 11230@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
2efea8c0 11231If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
11232instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
11233just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
11234
11235The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
11236it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
11237laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
11238Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
11239
11240You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
11241definition is null.
11242@end deftypefn
11243
ddc6a57f 11244@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
fc2a2dcb 11245Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11246that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
03b0fcfc 11247necessary setup.
11248
8e5fcce7 11249Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
03b0fcfc 11250instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
11251they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
11252instructions or prefetch instructions).
11253
e60d3615 11254To create a built-in function, call the function
11255@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
8e5fcce7 11256which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
c38a75b7 11257up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
747af5e7 11258only language front ends that use those two functions will call
fc2a2dcb 11259@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
6494208a 11260@end deftypefn
03b0fcfc 11261
5f77f12a 11262@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
8d134460 11263Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11264that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
11265builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
11266If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
11267if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
11268If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
11269@code{error_mark_node}.
11270@end deftypefn
11271
3754d046 11272@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
03b0fcfc 11273
8e5fcce7 11274Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
fc2a2dcb 11275@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
11276function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
11277convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
11278@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
11279@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
11280ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
11281built-in function.
6494208a 11282@end deftypefn
03b0fcfc 11283
058a1b7a 11284@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_CHKP_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{fcode})
11285This hook allows target to redefine built-in functions used by
11286Pointer Bounds Checker for code instrumentation. Hook should return
11287fndecl of function implementing generic builtin whose code is
11288passed in @var{fcode}. Currently following built-in functions are
11289obtained using this hook:
11290@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndmk (const void *@var{lb}, size_t @var{size})
11291Function code - BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDMK. This built-in function is used
11292by Pointer Bounds Checker to create bound values. @var{lb} holds low
11293bound of the resulting bounds. @var{size} holds size of created bounds.
11294@end deftypefn
11295
11296@deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndstx (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, const void **@var{loc})
11297Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDSTX}. This built-in function is used
11298by Pointer Bounds Checker to store bounds @var{b} for pointer @var{ptr}
11299when @var{ptr} is stored by address @var{loc}.
11300@end deftypefn
11301
11302@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndldx (const void **@var{loc}, const void *@var{ptr})
11303Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDLDX}. This built-in function is used
11304by Pointer Bounds Checker to get bounds of pointer @var{ptr} loaded by
11305address @var{loc}.
11306@end deftypefn
11307
11308@deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcl (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11309Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCL}. This built-in function is used
11310by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11311lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11312@end deftypefn
11313
11314@deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcu (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11315Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCU}. This built-in function is used
11316by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11317upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11318@end deftypefn
11319
11320@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndret (void *@var{ptr})
11321Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDRET}. This built-in function is used
11322by Pointer Bounds Checker to obtain bounds returned by a call statement.
11323@var{ptr} passed to built-in is @code{SSA_NAME} returned by the call.
11324@end deftypefn
11325
11326@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_intersect (__bounds_type @var{b1}, __bounds_type @var{b2})
11327Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_INTERSECT}. This built-in function
11328returns intersection of bounds @var{b1} and @var{b2}.
11329@end deftypefn
11330
11331@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_narrow (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, size_t @var{s})
11332Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_NARROW}. This built-in function
11333returns intersection of bounds @var{b} and
11334[@var{ptr}, @var{ptr} + @var{s} - @code{1}].
11335@end deftypefn
11336
11337@deftypefn {Built-in Function} size_t __chkp_sizeof (const void *@var{ptr})
11338Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_SIZEOF}. This built-in function
11339returns size of object referenced by @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} is always
11340@code{ADDR_EXPR} of @code{VAR_DECL}. This built-in is used by
11341Pointer Bounds Checker when bounds of object cannot be computed statically
11342(e.g. object has incomplete type).
11343@end deftypefn
11344
11345@deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_lower (__bounds_type @var{b})
11346Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_LOWER}. This built-in function
11347returns lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11348@end deftypefn
11349
11350@deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_upper (__bounds_type @var{b})
11351Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_UPPER}. This built-in function
11352returns upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11353@end deftypefn
11354@end deftypefn
11355@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_TYPE (void)
11356Return type to be used for bounds
11357@end deftypefn
582adad1 11358@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_MODE (void)
058a1b7a 11359Return mode to be used for bounds.
11360@end deftypefn
11361@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_MAKE_BOUNDS_CONSTANT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{lb}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{ub})
11362Return constant used to statically initialize constant bounds
11363with specified lower bound @var{lb} and upper bounds @var{ub}.
11364@end deftypefn
11365@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CHKP_INITIALIZE_BOUNDS (tree @var{var}, tree @var{lb}, tree @var{ub}, tree *@var{stmts})
11366Generate a list of statements @var{stmts} to initialize pointer
11367bounds variable @var{var} with bounds @var{lb} and @var{ub}. Return
11368the number of generated statements.
11369@end deftypefn
11370
78d39c62 11371@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
2e5ed910 11372Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
11373was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
11374@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
11375implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
11376declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
11377arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
11378complete expression that implements the operation, usually
11379another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
78d39c62 11380@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
2e5ed910 11381@end deftypefn
11382
97d67146 11383@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
0ab8af67 11384Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11385@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
97d67146 11386built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
11387the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
29cad3b6 11388The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
11389containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
11390@var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11391@end deftypefn
11392
11393@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
11394Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
11395by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
11396statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
11397was made to the GIMPLE stream.
60ad4151 11398@end deftypefn
11399
cc8ef84f 11400@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
11401This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
11402determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
11403during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
11404versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
11405is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
11406 the two function decls that will be compared.
11407@end deftypefn
11408
11409@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
11410This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
11411versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
11412version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
11413identical versions.
11414@end deftypefn
11415
11416@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
11417This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
11418function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
11419@var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
11420body must be generated.
11421@end deftypefn
11422
a04a7bec 11423@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
11424Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
11425and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the
11426exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives
11427the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is
11428the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
11429contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
11430loop is only entered from the top.
11431
11432This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default
11433implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
11434if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
11435@end deftypefn
11436
18282db0 11437@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
7dfa5ce3 11438
1606e68a 11439Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
f2779bd1 11440low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11441could not be applied.
7dfa5ce3 11442
1606e68a 11443Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11444instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
b215c058 11445the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
7dfa5ce3 11446By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
b215c058 11447loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
7dfa5ce3 11448@end deftypefn
11449
18282db0 11450@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
2a29bc01 11451Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
11452@end deftypefn
11453
484e0746 11454@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee})
c7b4d9b2 11455FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11456@end deftypefn
11457
5f77f12a 11458@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
280566a7 11459This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11460Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
a81d4cba 11461PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
280566a7 11462of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11463@end deftypefn
11464
edf54f2a 11465@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
9fc61494 11466
11467When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
20dd417a 11468register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
9fc61494 11469to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
edf54f2a 11470it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11471is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11472that had its initial value copied by using
9fc61494 11473@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11474Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11475to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11476the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11477@code{MEM}.
11478If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11479it might decide to use another register anyways.
81e483dd 11480You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11481@code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
9fc61494 11482register in question will not be clobbered.
edf54f2a 11483The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11484allocation.
11485@end deftypefn
9fc61494 11486
77ad8e5a 11487@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11488This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11489@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11490this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11491@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11492to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11493passed along.
11494@end deftypefn
11495
87d4aa85 11496@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
15b474a2 11497The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
87d4aa85 11498context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11499the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11500per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11501attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11502The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11503and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11504and is returning to processing at the top level.
11505The default hook function does nothing.
11506
11507GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11508some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11509situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11510or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
5f77f12a 11511@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11512outside of any function scope.
87d4aa85 11513@end deftypefn
11514
d37d6c0b 11515@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
531d4872 11516Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11517files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11518use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
d37d6c0b 11519@end defmac
531d4872 11520
d37d6c0b 11521@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
531d4872 11522Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11523automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11524do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11525executable files.
d37d6c0b 11526@end defmac
531d4872 11527
d37d6c0b 11528@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
531d4872 11529If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11530specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11531Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11532object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11533lists.
d37d6c0b 11534@end defmac
531d4872 11535
d37d6c0b 11536@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
760c3e42 11537Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11538method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11539must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
c20b542c 11540For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
760c3e42 11541the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11542defined as this expression:
11543
11544@smallexample
11545build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11546 build_tree_list
11547 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11548 NULL))
11549@end smallexample
d37d6c0b 11550@end defmac
e27e52e0 11551
11552@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11553This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11554instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11555every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11556reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11557
11558@smallexample
11559static bool
11560cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11561@{
11562 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11563@}
11564@end smallexample
11565@end deftypefn
8af3db02 11566
964229b7 11567@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
8af3db02 11568This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11569optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
c25e569a 11570usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
8af3db02 11571re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11572to inter-block scheduling.
11573@end deftypefn
11574
11575@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11576Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11577registers
11578that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11579returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11580that all target registers in the class returned by
11581@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11582saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11583epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11584true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11585to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11586to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11587@end deftypefn
f1b844c6 11588
751d3ba7 11589@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11590This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11591This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11592modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11593@end deftypefn
11594
d1ff5c63 11595@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1})
636fb80b 11596This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a
dad0993e 11597 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns an appropriate comparison
11598 with @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11599 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11600 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11601 compares in the the conditional comparision are generated without error.
11602 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
f9fd4edc 11603@end deftypefn
11604
d1ff5c63 11605@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code})
dad0993e 11606This function prepares to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence
11607 of conditional comparisons. It returns an appropriate comparison with
11608 @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11609 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11610 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11611 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error. The
11612 @var{prev} expression is the result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first}
11613 or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It may return @code{NULL} if the combination of
11614 @var{prev} and this comparison is not supported, otherwise the result must
11615 be appropriate for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11616 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11617 @var{bit_code} is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the compares.
f9fd4edc 11618@end deftypefn
11619
9ccaa774 11620@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11621This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11622should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11623the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11624the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11625is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11626number of memory accesses.
11627@end deftypefn
11628
f1b844c6 11629@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
894b8fd9 11630If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
f1b844c6 11631that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11632that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11633constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11634more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11635system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11636The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11637@end defmac
065e625b 11638
2288041e 11639@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
065e625b 11640This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11641target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
2288041e 11642are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11643The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11644@end deftypefn
11645
11646@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11647This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11648target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11649indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11650@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11651@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
065e625b 11652@end deftypefn
11653
11654@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11655This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11656The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11657systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11658that are different from @option{-I}.
11659@end deftypefn
5c0b8490 11660
5f77f12a 11661@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11662This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
5c0b8490 11663for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
5f77f12a 11664@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
805d6554 11665functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
5c0b8490 11666@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
5f77f12a 11667@end defmac
1e9af880 11668
11669@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11670If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11671target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11672option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11673@end defmac
11674
11675@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11676If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11677@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11678@end defmac
784d3782 11679
635c5a98 11680@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11681If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11682target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11683default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11684@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11685@end defmac
11686
11687@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11688If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11689@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11690@end defmac
11691
78e16ab5 11692@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11693If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11694routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11695and scanf formatter settings.
11696@end defmac
11697
ddc6a57f 11698@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
b215c058 11699If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11700illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
10fda9eb 11701with prototype @var{typelist}.
11702@end deftypefn
11703
ddc6a57f 11704@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
7a979707 11705If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11706invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11707if validity should be determined by the front end.
11708@end deftypefn
11709
ddc6a57f 11710@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
7a979707 11711If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11712invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11713@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11714if validity should be determined by the front end.
11715@end deftypefn
11716
ddc6a57f 11717@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
7a979707 11718If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11719invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11720and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11721the front end.
11722@end deftypefn
11723
ddc6a57f 11724@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
15b474a2 11725If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11726@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
2b3c93a3 11727analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11728front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11729target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11730This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11731@end deftypefn
11732
ddc6a57f 11733@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
15b474a2 11734If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11735@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
2b3c93a3 11736or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
15b474a2 11737This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
2b3c93a3 11738conversion rules.
11739This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11740@end deftypefn
11741
6db57367 11742@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11743This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11744NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11745@end defmac
07e0e650 11746
11747@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11748Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
15b474a2 11749to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
07e0e650 11750call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11751and the associated definitions of those functions.
11752@end defmac
658e203c 11753
27a7a23a 11754@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11755Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11756necessary.
11757@end deftypefn
11758
11759@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
5f77f12a 11760This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
27a7a23a 11761different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
5f77f12a 11762argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11763is needed.
27a7a23a 11764@end deftypefn
11765
ddc6a57f 11766@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
658e203c 11767When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11768arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11769stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11770debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11771@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11772cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11773to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11774false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11775@end deftypefn
01c8e4c9 11776
01c8e4c9 11777@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11778On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11779a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11780is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11781is computed from this register using immediate addition or
b6a556f8 11782subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
01c8e4c9 11783the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11784available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11785constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11786down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11787@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11788accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11789value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11790MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11791@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
99b33860 11792is zero, which disables this optimization.
11793@end deftypevr
df1680c8 11794
7ad5fd20 11795@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11796Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11797Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11798supported by the target.
11799@end deftypefn
11800
7f738025 11801@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11802Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11803memory model bits are allowed.
11804@end deftypefn
11805
df1680c8 11806@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11807This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11808@end deftypevr
df9f2e40 11809
11810@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11811It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11812The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11813The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11814@end deftypefn
e913b5cd 11815
3754d046 11816@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
1e6e32b6 11817If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
11818@end deftypefn
11819
b560fabd 11820@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
11821ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
11822@end deftypefn
55af3bae 11823
dccabdd1 11824@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree)
11825Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named
11826sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be
11827recorded in the offload function and variable table.
11828@end deftypefn
11829
38e21583 11830@deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void)
11831Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should
11832translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)
11833into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface
11834to express such options. It should return a string containing these options,
11835separated by spaces, which the caller will free.
11836
11837@end deftypefn
11838
e913b5cd 11839@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
11840
11841On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
a342dbb2 11842objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
11843to indicate that large integers are stored in
e913b5cd 11844@code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
11845very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
a342dbb2 11846is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
e913b5cd 11847representation.
11848
11849Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
a342dbb2 11850@code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
e913b5cd 11851code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
11852const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
11853need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
11854
11855@itemize @bullet
11856@item
11857There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
11858@code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
11859language since there are a variable number of elements.
11860
11861Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
11862value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
11863since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
11864are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
11865instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
11866However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
11867code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
11868not really a large change.
11869
11870@item
11871Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
11872constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
11873port in this code.
11874
11875@item
11876The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
11877constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
11878@end itemize
11879
a342dbb2 11880All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
e913b5cd 11881maintainer is familiar with.
11882
11883@end defmac
b07ada29 11884
11885@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RUN_TARGET_SELFTESTS (void)
11886If selftests are enabled, run any selftests for this target.
11887@end deftypefn